]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
PR27116, Spelling errors found by Debian style checker
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
250d07de 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
250d07de 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c
NC
87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
88\hfill nickc\@credhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
250d07de 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
abf874aa
CL
464@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
465@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
466This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
467fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
468section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
469error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
470several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
471section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
472sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
473
474@smallexample
475 MEMORY @{
476 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
477 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
478 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN : 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
479 @}
480 SECTIONS @{
481 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
482 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
483 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
484 @}
485
486 with input sections:
487 .data.1: size 8
488 .data.2: size 0x10
489 .data.3: size 4
490
491 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
492 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
493@end smallexample
494
495This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
496the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
497
498@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
499@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
500This option enables warnings when
501@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
502matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
503discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
504output region.
505
252b5132
RH
506@cindex entry point, from command line
507@kindex -e @var{entry}
508@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 509@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
510@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
511Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
512program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
513named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
514and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
515base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
516@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
517and other ways of specifying the entry point.
518
b58f81ae
DJ
519@kindex --exclude-libs
520@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
521Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 522exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
523@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
524automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
525port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
526explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
527option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
528be treated as hidden.
529
e1c37eb5
DK
530@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
531@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
532Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
533should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
534into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
535may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
536used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
537the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
538match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
539command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
540of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
541regardless of this option.
542
252b5132
RH
543@cindex dynamic symbol table
544@kindex -E
545@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 546@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
547@item -E
548@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
549@itemx --no-export-dynamic
550When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
551option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
552all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
553set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
554
555If you do not use either of these options (or use the
556@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
557dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
558referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
559
560If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
561back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
562dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
563linking the program itself.
564
55255dae 565You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 566be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 567See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 568
8b747e1a
DK
569Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
570support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
571the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
572
37a141bf
FS
573@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
574@cindex export dynamic symbol
575@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
576When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
577@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
578shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
579bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
580no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
581@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
582on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
583
584@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
585@cindex export dynamic symbol list
586@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
587Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
588The format of the file is the same as the version node without
589scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
590
36f63dca 591@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
592@cindex big-endian objects
593@cindex endianness
594@kindex -EB
595@item -EB
596Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
597
598@cindex little-endian objects
599@kindex -EL
600@item -EL
601Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 602@end ifclear
252b5132 603
2509a395
SL
604@kindex -f @var{name}
605@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
606@item -f @var{name}
607@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
608When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
609to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
610table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
611symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
612
613If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
614run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
615the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
616first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
617@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
618in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
619Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
620implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 621machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
622
623This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
624will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
625
2509a395
SL
626@kindex -F @var{name}
627@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 628@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 629@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
630When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
631the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
632of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
633on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
634
635If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
636run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
637dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
638filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
639found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
640used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
641@var{name}.
642
ff5dcc92 643Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 644toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
645object files.
646@ifclear SingleFormat
647The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 648@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 649@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
650environment variable.
651@end ifclear
652The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
653creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 654
3dbf70a2 655@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
656@kindex -fini=@var{name}
657@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
658When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
659executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
660address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
661the function to call.
662
252b5132
RH
663@kindex -g
664@item -g
665Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
666
2509a395
SL
667@kindex -G @var{value}
668@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 669@cindex object size
2509a395 670@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
671@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
672Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
673@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 674MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
675sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
676
677@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 678@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 679@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 680@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
681@itemx -soname=@var{name}
682When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
683the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
684which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
685linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
686field rather than the using the file name given to the linker.
687
688@kindex -i
689@cindex incremental link
690@item -i
691Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
692
3dbf70a2 693@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
694@kindex -init=@var{name}
695@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
696When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
697executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
698of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
699function to call.
700
252b5132 701@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 702@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 703@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 704@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
705@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
706Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
707list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
708If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 709will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 710will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 711
ff5dcc92 712On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
713files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
714and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
715called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
716@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
717indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
718to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
719@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
720
721The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
722specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
723was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
724command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
725archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
726the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
727
ff5dcc92 728See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
729archives multiple times.
730
731You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
732
733@ifset GENERIC
734This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 735if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
736behaviour of the AIX linker.
737@end ifset
738
739@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 740@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 741@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 742@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 743@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
744Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
745for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
746option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
747in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
748on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 749@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
750order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
751how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
752option is specified.
252b5132 753
3aa2d05a
NC
754If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
755prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
756@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 757
252b5132
RH
758@ifset UsesEnvVars
759The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 760@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
761some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
762@end ifset
763
764The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
765@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
766at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
767
768@cindex emulation
769@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 770@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
771Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
772emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
773
774If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
775@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
776
777Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
778configured.
779
780@cindex link map
781@kindex -M
782@kindex --print-map
783@item -M
784@itemx --print-map
785Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
786information about the link, including the following:
787
788@itemize @bullet
789@item
3b83e13a 790Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
791@item
792How common symbols are allocated.
793@item
794All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
795which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
796@item
797The values assigned to symbols.
798
799Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
800involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
801have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
802linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
803of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
804the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
805linker script containing:
806
807@smallexample
808 foo = 1
809 foo = foo * 4
810 foo = foo + 8
811@end smallexample
812
813will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
814option is used:
815
816@smallexample
817 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
818 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
819 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
820@end smallexample
821
822See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
823scripts.
d2ef37eb 824
06ddcada
AM
825@item
826How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 827
06ddcada
AM
828When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
829.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
830These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
831
832@smallexample
833Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
834@end smallexample
835
06ddcada 836This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
837merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
838is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
839
840@smallexample
06ddcada 841Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
842@end smallexample
843
06ddcada 844This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
845when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
846is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
847@end itemize
848
035801ce
FS
849@cindex link map discarded
850@kindex --print-map-discarded
851@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
852@item --print-map-discarded
853@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
854Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
855in the link map. Enabled by default.
856
252b5132
RH
857@kindex -n
858@cindex read-only text
859@cindex NMAGIC
860@kindex --nmagic
861@item -n
862@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
863Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
864libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
865mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
866
867@kindex -N
868@kindex --omagic
869@cindex read/write from cmd line
870@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 871@item -N
252b5132
RH
872@itemx --omagic
873Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
874not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
875libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
876mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
877is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
878specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
879
880@kindex --no-omagic
881@cindex OMAGIC
882@item --no-omagic
883This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
884sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
885be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
886shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
887
888@kindex -o @var{output}
889@kindex --output=@var{output}
890@cindex naming the output file
891@item -o @var{output}
892@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 893Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
894option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
895script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
896
f37b21b4
RM
897@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
898@cindex dependency file
899@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
900Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
901suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
902that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
903output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
904Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
905Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
906to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
907linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
908@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
909installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
910distributed makefiles without careful editing.
911
252b5132
RH
912@kindex -O @var{level}
913@cindex generating optimized output
914@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 915If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 916the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
917should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
918option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
919the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
920no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
921of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 922
387dd777
DP
923@kindex -plugin @var{name}
924@item -plugin @var{name}
925Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
926the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
927automatically added by the complier, when using link time
928optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
929wish.
930
931Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
932from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
933@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
934those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 935copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 936based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 937just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 938
26278bb8
UD
939@kindex --push-state
940@cindex push state governing input file handling
941@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 942The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
943flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
944restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
945
946The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
947@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
948@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
949@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
950@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
951@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
952
953One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
954used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
955listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
956something as follows:
957
958@smallexample
959-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
960@end smallexample
961
962@kindex --pop-state
963@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 964@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
965Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
966flags governing input file handling.
967
a712da20
NC
968@kindex -q
969@kindex --emit-relocs
970@cindex retain relocations in final executable
971@item -q
972@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 973Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
974Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
975order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
976in larger executables.
977
dbab7a7b
NC
978This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
979
4f471f39
RS
980@kindex --force-dynamic
981@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
982@item --force-dynamic
983Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
984to VxWorks targets.
985
252b5132
RH
986@cindex partial link
987@cindex relocatable output
988@kindex -r
1049f94e 989@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 990@item -r
1049f94e 991@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 992Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 993turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
994linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
995magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
996@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 997@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
998If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
999linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1000constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1001
62bf86b4
HPN
1002When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1003partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1004relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1005example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1006with input files in other formats at all.
1007
252b5132
RH
1008This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1009
1010@kindex -R @var{file}
1011@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1012@cindex symbol-only input
1013@item -R @var{filename}
1014@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1015Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1016relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1017to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1018programs. You may use this option more than once.
1019
ff5dcc92 1020For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1021followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1022the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1023
1024@kindex -s
1025@kindex --strip-all
1026@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1027@item -s
252b5132
RH
1028@itemx --strip-all
1029Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1030
1031@kindex -S
1032@kindex --strip-debug
1033@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1034@item -S
252b5132
RH
1035@itemx --strip-debug
1036Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1037
a70f34c0
NC
1038@kindex --strip-discarded
1039@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1040@item --strip-discarded
1041@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1042Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1043Enabled by default.
1044
252b5132
RH
1045@kindex -t
1046@kindex --trace
1047@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1048@item -t
252b5132 1049@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1050Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1051@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1052@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1053and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1054a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1055
1056@kindex -T @var{script}
1057@kindex --script=@var{script}
1058@cindex script files
1059@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1060@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1061Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
ff5dcc92 1062@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it), so
252b5132 1063@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1064output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1065the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1066specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1067options accumulate.
252b5132 1068
14be8564
L
1069@kindex -dT @var{script}
1070@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1071@cindex script files
1072@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1073@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1074Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1075
1076This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1077processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1078command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1079@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1080behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1081command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1082the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1083@samp{gcc}).
1084
252b5132
RH
1085@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1086@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1087@cindex undefined symbol
1088@item -u @var{symbol}
1089@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1090Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1091symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1092modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1093different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1094option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1095
0a618243
AB
1096If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1097into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1098undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1099instead.
1100
1101@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1102@cindex symbols, require defined
1103@cindex defined symbol
1104@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1105Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1106is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1107is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1108and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1109@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1110can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1111
252b5132
RH
1112@kindex -Ur
1113@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1114@item -Ur
252b5132
RH
1115For anything other than C++ programs, this option is equivalent to
1116@samp{-r}: it generates relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1117turn serve as input to @command{ld}. When linking C++ programs, @samp{-Ur}
252b5132
RH
1118@emph{does} resolve references to constructors, unlike @samp{-r}.
1119It does not work to use @samp{-Ur} on files that were themselves linked
1120with @samp{-Ur}; once the constructor table has been built, it cannot
1121be added to. Use @samp{-Ur} only for the last partial link, and
1122@samp{-r} for the others.
1123
c005eb9e
AB
1124@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1125@cindex orphan sections
1126@cindex sections, orphan
1127@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1128Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1129specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1130
1131@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1132
1133@table @code
1134@item place
1135Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1136the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1137@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1138
1139@item discard
1140All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1141@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1142
1143@item warn
1144The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1145issue a warning.
1146
1147@item error
1148The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1149@end table
1150
1151The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1152
577a0623
AM
1153@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1154@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1155Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1156@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1157missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1158specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1159multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1160input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1161in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1162
252b5132
RH
1163@kindex -v
1164@kindex -V
1165@kindex --version
1166@cindex version
1167@item -v
1168@itemx --version
1169@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1170Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
252b5132
RH
1171lists the supported emulations.
1172
1173@kindex -x
1174@kindex --discard-all
1175@cindex deleting local symbols
1176@item -x
1177@itemx --discard-all
1178Delete all local symbols.
1179
1180@kindex -X
1181@kindex --discard-locals
1182@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1183@item -X
252b5132 1184@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1185Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1186system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1187or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1188
1189@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1190@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1191@cindex symbol tracing
1192@item -y @var{symbol}
1193@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1194Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1195option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1196to prepend an underscore.
1197
1198This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1199don't know where the reference is coming from.
1200
1201@kindex -Y @var{path}
1202@item -Y @var{path}
1203Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1204for Solaris compatibility.
1205
1206@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1207@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1208The recognized keywords are:
1209@table @samp
1210
e6e2dfbd
AM
1211@item bndplt
1212Always generate BND prefix in PLT entries. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1213
1214@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1215@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1216@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1217@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1218Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1219to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1220@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1221@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1222@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1223@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1224Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1225
233a0083
L
1226@item cet-report=none
1227@itemx cet-report=warning
1228@itemx cet-report=error
1229Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1230GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1231section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1232linker not report missing properties in input files.
1233@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1234missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1235the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1236Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1237GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1238turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1239Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1240
cd6d6c15 1241@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1242@itemx nocombreloc
1243Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1244dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1245
b8871f35 1246@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1247@itemx nocommon
1248Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1249link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1250
1251@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1252Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1253layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1254using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1255
cd6d6c15 1256@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1257Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1258is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1259This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1260
e6e2dfbd
AM
1261@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1262@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1263Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1264if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1265by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1266@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1267may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1268selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1269these options.
1270
6aa29e7b
JJ
1271@item execstack
1272Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1273
b039ef04
L
1274@item global
1275This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1276the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1277of subsequently loaded libraries.
1278
93ab9c0d
NC
1279@item globalaudit
1280This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1281This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1282setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1283tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1284the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1285all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1286
e6e2dfbd
AM
1287@item ibtplt
1288Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1289Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1290
8df93cb5 1291@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1292Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1293to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1294Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1295
cd6d6c15
NC
1296@item initfirst
1297This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1298It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1299before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1300the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1301the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1302objects.
1303
1304@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1306so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1307libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1308
c3805e4c
VDM
1309@item unique
1310@itemx nounique
1311When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1312object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1313and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1314primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1315al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1316of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1317and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1318
279d901e
L
1319@item lam-u48
1320Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1321to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1322
1323@item lam-u57
1324Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1325to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1326
1327@item lam-u48-report=none
1328@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1329@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1330Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1331property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1332@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1333linker not report missing properties in input files.
1334@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1335missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1336make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1337Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1338
1339@item lam-u57-report=none
1340@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1341@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1342Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1343property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1344@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1345linker not report missing properties in input files.
1346@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1347missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1348make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1349Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1350
1351@item lam-report=none
1352@itemx lam-report=warning
1353@itemx lam-report=error
1354Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1355GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1356section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1357linker not report missing properties in input files.
1358@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1359missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1360the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1361Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1362
5fa222e4
AM
1363@item lazy
1364When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1365dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1366the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1367Lazy binding is the default.
1368
cd6d6c15 1369@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1370Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1371
e6e2dfbd
AM
1372@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1373Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1374
e6e2dfbd
AM
1375@item muldefs
1376Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1377
cd6d6c15 1378@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1379Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1380defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1381
1382@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1384should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1385
1386@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1387Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1388
1389@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1390Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1391
1392@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1393Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1394
6aa29e7b
JJ
1395@item noexecstack
1396Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1397
e6e2dfbd
AM
1398@item noextern-protected-data
1399Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1400library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1401used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1402generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1403module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1404i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1405
e6e2dfbd
AM
1406@item noreloc-overflow
1407Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1408relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1409overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1410
cd6d6c15
NC
1411@item now
1412When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1413dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1414when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1415function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1416called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1417
1418@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1419Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1420
6aa29e7b 1421@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1422@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1423Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1424specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1425relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1426than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1427Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1428
47acac12
L
1429@item separate-code
1430@itemx noseparate-code
1431Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1432specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1433be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1434code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1435
496afd17
L
1436@item unique-symbol
1437@itemx nounique-symbol
1438Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1439".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1440is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1441
e6e2dfbd
AM
1442@item shstk
1443Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1444to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1445Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1446
04c3a755 1447@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1448Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1449Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1450@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1451
cae64165
RM
1452@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1453@cindex visibility
1454@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1455Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1456@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1457Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1458@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1459start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1460compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1461recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1462programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1463between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1464
e6e2dfbd
AM
1465@item text
1466@itemx notext
1467@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1468Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1469or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1470report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1471
97a232d7
NC
1472@item undefs
1473Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1474either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1475This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1476
b0ab0693 1477@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1478@item x86-64-v2
1479@item x86-64-v3
1480@itemx x86-64-v4
1481Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1482@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1483@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1484@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1485@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1486Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1487
cd6d6c15
NC
1488@end table
1489
ece2d90e 1490Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1491
1492@kindex -(
1493@cindex groups of archives
1494@item -( @var{archives} -)
1495@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1496The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1497either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1498
1499The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1500references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1501the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1502archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1503object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1504would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1505they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1506resolved.
1507
1508Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1509it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1510more archives.
1511
69da35b5
NC
1512@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1513@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1514@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1515@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1516Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1517recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1518and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1519the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1520behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1521so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1522restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1523
4a43e768
AM
1524@kindex --as-needed
1525@kindex --no-as-needed
1526@item --as-needed
1527@itemx --no-as-needed
1528This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1529on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1530the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1531on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1532needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1533emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1534non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1535the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1536non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1537Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1538the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1539needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1540from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1541
e56f61be
L
1542@kindex --add-needed
1543@kindex --no-add-needed
1544@item --add-needed
1545@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1546These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1547their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1548options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1549and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1550
252b5132
RH
1551@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1552@item -assert @var{keyword}
1553This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1554
1555@kindex -Bdynamic
1556@kindex -dy
1557@kindex -call_shared
1558@item -Bdynamic
1559@itemx -dy
1560@itemx -call_shared
1561Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1562for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1563default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1564for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1565multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1566@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1567
a1ab1d2a
UD
1568@kindex -Bgroup
1569@item -Bgroup
1570Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1571section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1572object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1573@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1574only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1575
252b5132
RH
1576@kindex -Bstatic
1577@kindex -dn
1578@kindex -non_shared
1579@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1580@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1581@itemx -dn
1582@itemx -non_shared
1583@itemx -static
1584Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1585platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1586variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1587may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1588library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1589option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1590option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1591shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1592references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1593libraries.
252b5132
RH
1594
1595@kindex -Bsymbolic
1596@item -Bsymbolic
1597When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1598definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1599for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1600within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1601platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1602
40b36307
L
1603@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1604@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1605When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1606symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1607This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1608libraries.
40b36307 1609
55255dae
L
1610@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1611@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1612Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1613typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1614global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1615within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1616to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1617in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1618which support shared libraries.
1619
1620The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1621scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1622
40b36307
L
1623@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1624@item --dynamic-list-data
1625Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1626
1627@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1628@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1629Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1630is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1631
0b8a70d9
L
1632@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1633@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1634Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1635
252b5132
RH
1636@kindex --check-sections
1637@kindex --no-check-sections
1638@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1639@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1640Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1641been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1642perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1643suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1644allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1645restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1646Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1647force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1648option.
252b5132 1649
ddbb8a31
NC
1650@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1651@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1652@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1653@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1654This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1655by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1656command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1657output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1658input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1659specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1660follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1661behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1662
1663This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1664libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1665mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1666their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1667required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1668the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1669dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1670symbols.
1671
252b5132
RH
1672@cindex cross reference table
1673@kindex --cref
1674@item --cref
1675Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1676generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1677Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1678
1679The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1680easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1681sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1682symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1683definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1684where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1685symbol are listed.
252b5132 1686
5dba6f05
NA
1687@cindex ctf variables
1688@kindex --ctf-variables
1689@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1690@item --ctf-variables
1691@item --no-ctf-variables
1692The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1693types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1694table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1695conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1696usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1697@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1698The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1699
1700@cindex ctf type sharing
1701@kindex --ctf-share-types
1702@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1703Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1704
1705@table @samp
1706@item share-unconflicted
1707Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1708where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1709translation unit. This is the default.
1710
1711@item share-duplicated
1712Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1713dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1714dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1715always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1716larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1717large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1718consumer at runtime.
1719@end table
1720
4818e05f
AM
1721@cindex common allocation
1722@kindex --no-define-common
1723@item --no-define-common
1724This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1725The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1726@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1727
1728The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1729the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1730of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1731forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1732Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1733from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1734This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1735and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1736duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1737paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1738
7bdf4127
AB
1739@cindex group allocation in linker script
1740@cindex section groups
1741@cindex COMDAT
1742@kindex --force-group-allocation
1743@item --force-group-allocation
1744This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1745normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1746default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1747change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1748command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1749effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1750
252b5132 1751@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1752@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1753@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1754Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1755address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1756times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1757limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1758context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1759symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1760constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1761using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1762@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1763equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1764
54874444
AB
1765The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1766in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1767symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1768placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1769the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1770consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1771@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1772you are trying to achieve.
1773
252b5132 1774@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1775@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1776@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1777@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1778@itemx --no-demangle
1779These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1780and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1781present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1782underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1783mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1784different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1785to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1786demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1787is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1788
1789@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1790@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1791@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1792@item -I@var{file}
1793@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1794Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1795generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1796linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1797doing.
1798
9b8b325a
RF
1799@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1800@item --no-dynamic-linker
1801When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1802linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1803executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1804entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1805
a70f34c0
NC
1806@kindex --embedded-relocs
1807@item --embedded-relocs
1808This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1809that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1810is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1811targets.
1812
3f0a5f17
ME
1813@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1814@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1815Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1816in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1817
7ce691ae 1818@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1819@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1820@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1821@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1822Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1823with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1824
252b5132
RH
1825@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1826@item --force-exe-suffix
1827Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1828
1829If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1830@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1831the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1832option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1833Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1834it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1835
1836@kindex --gc-sections
1837@kindex --no-gc-sections
1838@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1839@item --gc-sections
1840@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 1841Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 1842targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 1843performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
1844@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
1845collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
1846implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 1847
d5465ba2
AM
1848@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
1849examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
1850symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
1851command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
1852referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
1853libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
1854referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
1855the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
1856relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
1857@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 1858
ac69cbc6 1859This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 1860@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
1861specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
1862@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
1863command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 1864
99fabbc9
JL
1865As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
1866@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
1867
c17d87de
NC
1868@kindex --print-gc-sections
1869@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
1870@cindex garbage collection
1871@item --print-gc-sections
1872@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
1873List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
1874printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
1875collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
1876default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
1877be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
1878line.
1879
22185505 1880@kindex --gc-keep-exported
1881@cindex garbage collection
1882@item --gc-keep-exported
1883When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
1884collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
1885default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
1886executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
1887collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
1888Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
1889it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
1890ELF format targets.
1891
30824704
RM
1892@kindex --print-output-format
1893@cindex output format
1894@item --print-output-format
1895Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
1896other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
1897in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
1898
3604cb1f
TG
1899@kindex --print-memory-usage
1900@cindex memory usage
1901@item --print-memory-usage
1902Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
1903the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
1904quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
1905headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
1906parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
1907
1908@smallexample
1909Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
1910 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
1911 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
1912@end smallexample
1913
252b5132
RH
1914@cindex help
1915@cindex usage
1916@kindex --help
1917@item --help
1918Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
1919
ea20a7da
CC
1920@kindex --target-help
1921@item --target-help
a094d01f 1922Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 1923
2509a395
SL
1924@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
1925@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 1926Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
1927@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
1928@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
1929
1930Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
1931written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
1932inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
1933file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
1934@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
1935output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
1936@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
1937
1938@smallexample
1939 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1940 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
1941 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1942 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1943 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
1944 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
1945 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
1946 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
1947 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
1948 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
1949@end smallexample
1950
1951It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
1952
1953If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
1954operation.
252b5132
RH
1955
1956@cindex memory usage
1957@kindex --no-keep-memory
1958@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
1959@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
1960symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 1961instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 1962necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
1963while linking a large executable.
1964
1965@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1966@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 1967@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 1968@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 1969@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
1970Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1971is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1972The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
1973behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 1974libraries being linked in.
252b5132 1975
97a232d7
NC
1976The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
1977
aa713662
L
1978@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
1979@kindex -z muldefs
1980@item --allow-multiple-definition
1981@itemx -z muldefs
1982Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
1983report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
1984first definition will be used.
1985
b79e8c78 1986@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1987@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 1988@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 1989@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 1990Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
1991This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
1992determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
1993shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
1994how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
1995
903249d7
NC
1996The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
1997referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
1998an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
1999a shared library.
2000
2001The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2002libraries specified at link time are that:
2003
2004@itemize @bullet
2005@item
2006A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2007that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2008resolvable at load time.
2009@item
2010There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2011symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2012
2013The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2014select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2015architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2016appropriate memset function.
2017@end itemize
b79e8c78 2018
23ae20f5
NC
2019@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2020@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2021If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2022@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2023only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2024libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
93cf38c0
NC
2025``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
2026undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2027will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2028might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2029error message will be displayed.
2030
2031The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2032switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2033
31941635
L
2034@kindex --no-undefined-version
2035@item --no-undefined-version
2036Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2037it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2038will be issued instead.
2039
3e3b46e5
PB
2040@kindex --default-symver
2041@item --default-symver
2042Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2043exported symbols.
2044
2045@kindex --default-imported-symver
2046@item --default-imported-symver
2047Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2048imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2049
252b5132
RH
2050@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2051@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2052Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2053files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2054been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2055This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2056errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2057have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2058inappropriate.
2059
fe7929ce
AM
2060@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2061@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2062Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2063library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2064
252b5132
RH
2065@kindex --no-whole-archive
2066@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2067Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2068archive files.
2069
2070@cindex output file after errors
2071@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2072@item --noinhibit-exec
2073Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2074Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2075errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2076when it issues any error whatsoever.
2077
0a9c1c8e
CD
2078@kindex -nostdlib
2079@item -nostdlib
2080Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2081command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2082(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2083
252b5132 2084@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2085@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2086@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2087@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2088file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2089@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2090object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2091object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2092should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2093usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2094name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2095list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2096command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2097this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2098@end ifclear
2099
76359541
TP
2100@kindex --out-implib
2101@item --out-implib @var{file}
2102Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2103the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2104library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2105may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2106behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2107step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2108the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2109
36af4a4e
JJ
2110@kindex -pie
2111@kindex --pic-executable
2112@item -pie
2113@itemx --pic-executable
2114@cindex position independent executables
2115Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2116ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2117libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2118address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2119normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2120defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2121
252b5132
RH
2122@kindex -qmagic
2123@item -qmagic
2124This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2125
2126@kindex -Qy
2127@item -Qy
2128This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2129
2130@kindex --relax
2131@cindex synthesizing linker
2132@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2133@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2134@item --relax
28d5f677 2135@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2136An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2137@ifset GENERIC
2138This option is only supported on a few targets.
2139@end ifset
2140@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2141@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2142@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2143@ifset XTENSA
2144@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2145@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2146@ifset M68HC11
2147@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2148@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2149@ifset NIOSII
2150@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2151@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2152@ifset POWERPC
2153@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2154@end ifset
252b5132 2155
ccd9fae5 2156On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2157global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2158addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2159synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2160instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2161
2162On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2163debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2164@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2165This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2166family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2167@end ifset
2168
ccd9fae5
NC
2169On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2170@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2171
ccd9fae5
NC
2172On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2173and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
2174
252b5132
RH
2175@cindex retaining specified symbols
2176@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2177@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2178@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2179@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2180Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2181discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2182symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2183@ifset GENERIC
2184(such as VxWorks)
2185@end ifset
2186where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2187run-time memory.
2188
2189@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2190or symbols needed for relocations.
2191
2192You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2193line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2194
2195@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2196@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2197@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2198@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2199Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2200linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2201arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2202them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2203
2204The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2205are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2206description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2207in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2208have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2209
2210If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2211contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2212is defined.
252b5132 2213
ff5dcc92 2214The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2215SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2216@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2217runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2218options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2219gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2220file systems.
252b5132 2221
ff5dcc92 2222For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2223followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2224the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2225@end ifset
2226
2227@ifset GENERIC
2228@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2229@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2230@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2231When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2232happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2233of the input files.
2234
2235When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2236non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2237shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2238explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2239specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2240@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2241either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2242appearing multiple times.
2243
e680a6b6
NC
2244The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2245directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2246containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2247and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
224864-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2249
2250The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2251@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2252supported.
2253
28c309a2
NC
2254This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2255that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2256is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2257runtime linker would do.
2258
252b5132 2259The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2260libraries:
d8e4137b 2261
252b5132
RH
2262@enumerate
2263@item
ff5dcc92 2264Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2265@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2266Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2267between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2268specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2269used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2270at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2271by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2272the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2273@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2274On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2275@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2276environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2277@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2278On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2279directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2280@item
a1b8d843 2281For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2282variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2283@item
ec4eb78a
L
2284For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2285@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2286libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2287@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2288@item
252b5132
RH
2289The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2290@item
d8e4137b
NC
2291For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2292exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2293to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2294defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2295configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2296@item
2297For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2298the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2299header file.
2300@item
2301Any directories specifed by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in the
2302linker script being used.
252b5132
RH
2303@end enumerate
2304
2305If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2306warning and continue with the link.
2307@end ifset
2308
2309@kindex -shared
2310@kindex -Bshareable
2311@item -shared
2312@itemx -Bshareable
2313@cindex shared libraries
2314Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2315and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2316shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2317undefined symbols in the link.
2318
252b5132 2319@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2320@item --sort-common
2321@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2322@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2323This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2324ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2325sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2326eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2327between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2328specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2329
2509a395
SL
2330@kindex --sort-section=name
2331@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2332This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2333patterns in the linker script.
2334
2509a395
SL
2335@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2336@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2337This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2338patterns in the linker script.
2339
a70f34c0
NC
2340@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2341@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2342This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2343.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2344post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2345
252b5132 2346@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2347@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2348Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2349each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2350size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2351
2352@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2353@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2354Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2355output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2356This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2357certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2358cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2359that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2360support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2361input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2362more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2363many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2364
2365@kindex --stats
2366@item --stats
2367Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2368as execution time and memory usage.
2369
2509a395 2370@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2371@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2372Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2373configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2374that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2375
a70f34c0
NC
2376@kindex --task-link
2377@item --task-link
2378This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2379file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2380
252b5132
RH
2381@kindex --traditional-format
2382@cindex traditional format
2383@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2384For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2385the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2386use the traditional format instead.
2387
2388@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2389For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2390symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2391full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2392@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2393trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2394combine duplicate entries.
2395
2509a395
SL
2396@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2397@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2398Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2399address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2400times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2401line.
2402@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2403for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2404@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2405should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2406sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2407
2509a395
SL
2408@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2409@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2410@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2411@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2412@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2413@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2414@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2415Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2416@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2417
2509a395
SL
2418@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2419@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2420@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2421When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2422byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2423
9d5777a3
RM
2424@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2425@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2426@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2427When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2428the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2429text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2430
0d705e9f
AM
2431@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2432@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2433@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2434When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2435model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2436
560e09e9
NC
2437@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2438@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2439Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2440values for @samp{method}:
2441
2442@table @samp
2443@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2444Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2445
2446@item report-all
da8bce14 2447Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2448
2449@item ignore-in-object-files
2450Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2451ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2452
2453@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2454Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2455ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2456when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2457libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2458command line.
2459@end table
2460
2461The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2462by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2463
2464Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2465unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2466can change this to a warning.
2467
1715a13c
L
2468@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2469@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2470@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2471@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2472Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2473supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2474the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2475argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2476
2477@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2478@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2479@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2480Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2481used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2482about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2483is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2484see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2485use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2486symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2487@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2488
7ce691ae 2489@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2490@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2491@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2492@item --warn-common
2493Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2494a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2495but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2496you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2497Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2498warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2499
2500There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2501
2502@table @samp
2503@item int i = 1;
2504A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2505file.
2506
2507@item extern int i;
2508An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2509There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2510variable somewhere.
2511
2512@item int i;
2513A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2514variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2515The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2516single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2517size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2518a definition of the same variable.
2519@end table
2520
2521The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2522Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2523just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2524encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2525a common symbol.
2526
2527@enumerate
2528@item
2529Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2530definition for the symbol.
2531@smallexample
2532@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2533 overridden by definition
2534@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2535@end smallexample
2536
2537@item
2538Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2539the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2540except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2541@smallexample
2542@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2543 overriding common
2544@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2545@end smallexample
2546
2547@item
2548Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2549@smallexample
2550@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2551 of `@var{symbol}'
2552@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2553@end smallexample
2554
2555@item
2556Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2557@smallexample
2558@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2559 overridden by larger common
2560@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2561@end smallexample
2562
2563@item
2564Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2565the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2566encountered in a different order.
2567@smallexample
2568@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2569 overriding smaller common
2570@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2571@end smallexample
2572@end enumerate
2573
2574@kindex --warn-constructors
2575@item --warn-constructors
2576Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2577object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2578detect the use of global constructors.
2579
2580@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2581@item --warn-multiple-gp
2582Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2583This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2584Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2585section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2586of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2587base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2588base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2589bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2590large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2591values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2592option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2593
2594@kindex --warn-once
2595@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2596@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2597@item --warn-once
2598Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2599which refers to it.
2600
2601@kindex --warn-section-align
2602@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2603@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2604@item --warn-section-align
2605Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2606alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2607The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2608is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2609the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2610
a6dbf402
L
2611@kindex --warn-textrel
2612@item --warn-textrel
2613Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2614or shared object.
8fdd7217 2615
a0c402a5
L
2616@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2617@item --warn-alternate-em
2618Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2619
560e09e9
NC
2620@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2621@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2622If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2623@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2624This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2625
2626@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2627@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2628This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2629it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2630
252b5132
RH
2631@kindex --whole-archive
2632@cindex including an entire archive
2633@item --whole-archive
2634For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2635@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2636in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2637files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2638library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2639library. This option may be used more than once.
2640
7ec229ce 2641Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2642about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2643Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2644list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2645your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2646
2509a395
SL
2647@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2648@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2649Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2650@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2651undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2652@var{symbol}.
2653
2654This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2655wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2656wishes to call the system function, it should call
2657@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2658
2659Here is a trivial example:
2660
2661@smallexample
2662void *
cc2f008e 2663__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2664@{
cc2f008e 2665 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2666 return __real_malloc (c);
2667@}
2668@end smallexample
2669
ff5dcc92 2670If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2671all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2672instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2673call the real @code{malloc} function.
2674
2675You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2676links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2677you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2678file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2679call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2680
4ea904ed
SH
2681Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2682internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2683@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2684@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2685
2686@smallexample
2687int
2688f (void)
2689@{
2690 return 123;
2691@}
2692
2693int
2694g (void)
2695@{
2696 return f();
2697@}
2698@end smallexample
2699
6aa29e7b 2700@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2701@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2702@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2703@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2704Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2705(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2706section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2707
e41b3a13
JJ
2708@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2709@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2710Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2711generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
2712if linker generated unwind info is supported.
2713
6c1439be
L
2714@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2715@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2716@item --enable-new-dtags
2717@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2718This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2719systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2720@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2721and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2722If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2723created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2724those options are only available for ELF systems.
2725
2d643429 2726@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2727@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2728Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2729close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2730time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2731increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2732value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2733
fdc90cb4
JJ
2734@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2735@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2736Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2737@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2738new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2739the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2740hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2741but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2742
0ce398f1
L
2743@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2744@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2745@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2746@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2747@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2748@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2749@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2750@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
9af89fba
NC
2751On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2752compressed using zlib.
2753
2754@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2755sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2756DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2757instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2758also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2759sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2760
2761The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2762@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2763
2764Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2765sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2766for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2767uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2768
2769The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
2770involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
2771default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
2772@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 2773
35835446
JR
2774@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
2775@item --reduce-memory-overheads
2776This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 2777linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 2778for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
2779about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
2780
4f9c04f7 2781Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 27821021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 2783run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
2784has been used.
2785
2786The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
2787enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 2788
c0065db7
RM
2789@kindex --build-id
2790@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
2791@item --build-id
2792@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 2793Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 2794or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
2795unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
2796@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
2797@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
2798@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
2799the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
2800string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
2801@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
2802is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
2803
2804The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
2805that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
2806unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
2807to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
2808file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
2809string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
2810
2811Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
2812@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
252b5132
RH
2813@end table
2814
0285c67d
NC
2815@c man end
2816
36f63dca 2817@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 2818
0285c67d
NC
2819@c man begin OPTIONS
2820
ff5dcc92 2821The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
2822the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
2823normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
2824use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
2825@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
2826like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
2827symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
2828object file).
2829
2830In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 2831support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
2832PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
2833values by either a space or an equals sign.
2834
ff5dcc92 2835@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
2836
2837@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
2838@item --add-stdcall-alias
2839If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
2840as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 2841[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2842
2843@kindex --base-file
2844@item --base-file @var{file}
2845Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
2846addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
2847@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 2848[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
2849
2850@kindex --dll
2851@item --dll
2852Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 2853@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 2854file.
bb10df36 2855[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2856
88183869
DK
2857@kindex --enable-long-section-names
2858@kindex --disable-long-section-names
2859@item --enable-long-section-names
2860@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 2861The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 2862the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
2863for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
2864fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
2865to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
2866allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
2867disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
2868generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
2869as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
2870with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
2871GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
2872information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
2873option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
2874section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
2875when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
2876image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
2877[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
2878
252b5132
RH
2879@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
2880@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
2881@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
2882@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
2883If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 2884do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
2885only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
2886resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
2887undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
2888@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
2889to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
2890warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
2891import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 2892to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 2893feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 2894@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 2895mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 2896[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2897
522f09cd
KT
2898@kindex --leading-underscore
2899@kindex --no-leading-underscore
2900@item --leading-underscore
2901@itemx --no-leading-underscore
2902For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
2903in target's description. By this option it is possible to
2904disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
2905
252b5132
RH
2906@cindex DLLs, creating
2907@kindex --export-all-symbols
2908@item --export-all-symbols
2909If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
2910be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
2911otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
2912explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
2913attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
2914option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 2915@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 2916@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
2917exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
2918re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
2919such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
2920@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
2921@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
2922Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
2923not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 2924extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 2925(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 2926These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 2927@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 2928@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 2929@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 2930@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 2931[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2932
2933@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 2934@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
2935Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
2936exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 2937[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2938
2927aaca
NC
2939@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
2940@item --exclude-all-symbols
2941Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
2942[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2943
252b5132
RH
2944@kindex --file-alignment
2945@item --file-alignment
2946Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
2947file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
2948512.
bb10df36 2949[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2950
2951@cindex heap size
2952@kindex --heap
2953@item --heap @var{reserve}
2954@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 2955Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 2956to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 2957committed.
bb10df36 2958[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2959
2960@cindex image base
2961@kindex --image-base
2962@item --image-base @var{value}
2963Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
2964the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
2965is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
2966your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
2967other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
2968for dlls.
bb10df36 2969[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2970
2971@kindex --kill-at
2972@item --kill-at
2973If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
2974symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 2975[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 2976
26d2d8a2
BF
2977@kindex --large-address-aware
2978@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 2979If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 2980header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 2981greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
2982or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
2983section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
2984[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2985
f69a2f97
NC
2986@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
2987@item --disable-large-address-aware
2988Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
2989This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
2990driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
2991addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
2992[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
2993
252b5132
RH
2994@kindex --major-image-version
2995@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 2996Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 2997[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
2998
2999@kindex --major-os-version
3000@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3001Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3002[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3003
3004@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3005@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3006Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3007[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3008
3009@kindex --minor-image-version
3010@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3011Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3012[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3013
3014@kindex --minor-os-version
3015@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3016Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3017[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3018
3019@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3020@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3021Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3022[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3023
3024@cindex DEF files, creating
3025@cindex DLLs, creating
3026@kindex --output-def
3027@item --output-def @var{file}
3028The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3029file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3030(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3031library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3032automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3033[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3034
b044cda1 3035@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3036@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3037@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3038@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3039Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3040@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3041By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3042for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3043execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3044[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3045
3046@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3047@item --disable-auto-image-base
3048Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3049user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3050default.
bb10df36 3051[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3052
3053@cindex DLLs, linking to
3054@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3055@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3056When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3057search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3058@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3059between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3060uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3061@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3062[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3063
3064@kindex --enable-auto-import
3065@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3066Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3067DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3068mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3069[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3070
3071The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3072feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3073
3074Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3075of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3076PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3077
e2a83dd0
NC
3078Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3079data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3080placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3081around a problem with consts that is described here:
3082http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3083
4d8907ac
DS
3084Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3085see this message:
0d888aac 3086
ece2d90e 3087"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3088documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3089
ece2d90e
NC
3090This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3091ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3092allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3093fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3094constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3095multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3096this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3097of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3098the warning, and exit.
3099
3100There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3101data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3102
2fa9fc65
NC
3103One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3104of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3105this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3106
c0065db7
RM
3107A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3108that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3109there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3110a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3111
3112@example
3113extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3114extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3115 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3116@end example
3117
3118or
3119
3120@example
3121extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3122extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3123 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3124@end example
3125
c0065db7 3126For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3127is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3128
3129@example
3130extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3131extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3132 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3133@end example
3134
c406afaf
NC
3135or
3136
3137@example
3138extern long long extern_ll;
3139extern_ll -->
3140 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3141@end example
3142
2fa9fc65 3143A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3144'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3145@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3146requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3147building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3148merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3149between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3150constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3151
3152Original:
3153@example
3154--foo.h
3155extern int arr[];
3156--foo.c
3157#include "foo.h"
3158void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3159 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3160@}
3161@end example
3162
3163Solution 1:
3164@example
3165--foo.h
3166extern int arr[];
3167--foo.c
3168#include "foo.h"
3169void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3170 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3171 volatile int *parr = arr;
3172 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3173@}
3174@end example
3175
3176Solution 2:
3177@example
3178--foo.h
3179/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3180#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3181 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3182#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3183#else
3184#define FOO_IMPORT
3185#endif
3186extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3187--foo.c
3188#include "foo.h"
3189void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3190 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3191@}
3192@end example
3193
c0065db7 3194A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3195library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3196for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3197functions).
b044cda1
CW
3198
3199@kindex --disable-auto-import
3200@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3201Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3202@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3203[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3204
2fa9fc65
NC
3205@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3206@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3207If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3208that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3209a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3210environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3211[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3212
3213@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3214@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3215Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3216[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3217
b044cda1
CW
3218@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3219@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3220Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3221[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3222
252b5132
RH
3223@kindex --section-alignment
3224@item --section-alignment
3225Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3226addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3227[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3228
3229@cindex stack size
3230@kindex --stack
3231@item --stack @var{reserve}
3232@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3233Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3234to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3235committed.
bb10df36 3236[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3237
3238@kindex --subsystem
3239@item --subsystem @var{which}
3240@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3241@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3242Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3243legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3244@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3245the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3246@var{which}.
bb10df36 3247[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3248
2f563b51
DK
3249The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3250of the PE file header:
3251[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3252
2d5c3743
NC
3253@kindex --high-entropy-va
3254@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3255@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3256Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3257(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3258
dc9bd8c9
HD
3259This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3260@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3261
2f563b51
DK
3262@kindex --dynamicbase
3263@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3264@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3265The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3266randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3267Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3268can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3269This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3270
3271@kindex --forceinteg
3272@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3273@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3274Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3275default.
2f563b51
DK
3276
3277@kindex --nxcompat
3278@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3279@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3280The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3281This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3282targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3283
3284@kindex --no-isolation
3285@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3286@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3287Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3288This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3289
3290@kindex --no-seh
3291@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3292@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3293The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3294this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3295
3296@kindex --no-bind
3297@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3298@itemx --disable-no-bind
3299Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3300
3301@kindex --wdmdriver
3302@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3303@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3304The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3305by default.
9d5777a3 3306
2f563b51
DK
3307@kindex --tsaware
3308@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3309@itemx --disable-tsaware
3310The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3311default.
2f563b51 3312
0cb112f7
CF
3313@kindex --insert-timestamp
3314@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3315@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3316Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3317as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3318other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3319will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3320same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3321can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3322that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3323identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3324
3325@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3326@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3327@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3328Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3329is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3330This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3331@end table
3332
0285c67d
NC
3333@c man end
3334
ac145307
BS
3335@ifset C6X
3336@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3337
3338@c man begin OPTIONS
3339
3340The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3341libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3342all executables use an index of 0.
3343
3344@table @gcctabopt
3345
3346@kindex --dsbt-size
3347@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3348This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3349or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3350entries.
3351
3352@kindex --dsbt-index
3353@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3354This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3355to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3356executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3357@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3358
fbd9ad90
PB
3359@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3360The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3361exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3362
ac145307
BS
3363@end table
3364
3365@c man end
3366@end ifset
3367
b8891f8d
AJ
3368@ifset CSKY
3369@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3370
3371@c man begin OPTIONS
3372
3373@table @gcctabopt
3374
3375@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3376@item --branch-stub
3377This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3378sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3379usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3380can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3381the compiler or assembler.
3382
3383@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3384@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3385This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3386It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3387be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3388stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3389sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3390@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3391linker should choose suitable defaults.
3392
3393@end table
3394
3395@c man end
3396@end ifset
3397
93fd0973
SC
3398@ifset M68HC11
3399@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3400
3401@c man begin OPTIONS
3402
3403The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3404memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3405
3406@table @gcctabopt
3407
3408@kindex --no-trampoline
3409@item --no-trampoline
3410This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3411is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3412instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3413
3414@kindex --bank-window
3415@item --bank-window @var{name}
3416This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3417the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3418The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3419paging and addresses within the memory window.
3420
3421@end table
3422
3423@c man end
3424@end ifset
3425
7fb9f789
NC
3426@ifset M68K
3427@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3428
3429@c man begin OPTIONS
3430
3431The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3432when linking for 68K targets.
3433
3434@table @gcctabopt
3435
3436@kindex --got
3437@item --got=@var{type}
3438This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3439@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3440@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3441Info entry for @file{ld}.
3442
3443@end table
3444
3445@c man end
3446@end ifset
3447
833794fc
MR
3448@ifset MIPS
3449@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3450
3451@c man begin OPTIONS
3452
3453The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3454generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3455linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3456
3457@table @gcctabopt
3458
3459@kindex --insn32
3460@item --insn32
3461@kindex --no-insn32
3462@itemx --no-insn32
3463These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3464generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3465or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
346632-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3467used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3468possible.
3469
8b10b0b3
MR
3470@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3471@item --ignore-branch-isa
3472@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3473@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3474These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3475transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3476accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3477is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3478instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3479equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3480calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3481a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3482an error.
3483
3734320d
MF
3484@kindex --compact-branches
3485@item --compact-branches
3486@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3487@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3488These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3489in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3490
833794fc
MR
3491@end table
3492
3493@c man end
3494@end ifset
3495
fa1477dc
SC
3496
3497@ifset PDP11
3498@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3499
3500@c man begin OPTIONS
3501
3502For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3503produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3504for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3505targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3506defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3507here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3508
3509@table @gcctabopt
3510
3511@kindex -N
3512@item -N
3513@kindex --omagic
3514@itemx --omagic
3515
3516Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3517indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3518shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3519writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3520the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3521programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3522from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3523
3524@kindex -n
3525@item -n
3526@kindex --nmagic
3527@itemx --nmagic
3528
3529Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3530indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3531be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3532file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3533byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3534a @emph{pure executable} format.
3535
3536@kindex -z
3537@item -z
3538@kindex --imagic
3539@itemx --imagic
3540
3541Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3542indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3543data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3544instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3545larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3546to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3547shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3548option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3549and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3550this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3551executable} format.
3552
3553@kindex --no-omagic
3554@item --no-omagic
3555
3556Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3557
3558@end table
3559
3560@c man end
3561@end ifset
3562
252b5132
RH
3563@ifset UsesEnvVars
3564@node Environment
3565@section Environment Variables
3566
0285c67d
NC
3567@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3568
560e09e9 3569You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3570@ifclear SingleFormat
3571@code{GNUTARGET},
3572@end ifclear
3573@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3574
36f63dca 3575@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3576@kindex GNUTARGET
3577@cindex default input format
3578@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3579use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3580of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3581@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3582of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3583attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3584this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3585there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3586object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3587BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3588in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3589@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3590
3591@kindex LDEMULATION
3592@cindex default emulation
3593@cindex emulation, default
3594@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3595@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3596behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3597available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3598the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3599variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3600linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3601
3602@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3603@cindex demangling, default
3604Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3605@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3606default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3607a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3608may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3609options.
3610
0285c67d
NC
3611@c man end
3612@end ifset
3613
252b5132
RH
3614@node Scripts
3615@chapter Linker Scripts
3616
3617@cindex scripts
3618@cindex linker scripts
3619@cindex command files
3620Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3621written in the linker command language.
3622
3623The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3624the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3625the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3626more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3627direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3628described below.
3629
3630The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3631yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3632linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3633to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3634such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3635
3636You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3637line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3638default linker script.
3639
3640You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3641to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3642Linker Scripts}.
3643
3644@menu
3645* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3646* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3647* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3648* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3649* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3650* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3651* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3652* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3653* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3654* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3655* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3656@end menu
3657
3658@node Basic Script Concepts
3659@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3660@cindex linker script concepts
3661We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3662describe the linker script language.
3663
3664The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3665file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3666@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3667The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3668purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3669among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3670section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3671in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3672
3673Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3674also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3675contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3676the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3677A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3678area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3679loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3680which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3681of debugging information.
3682
3683Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3684first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3685the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3686@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3687section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3688same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3689is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3690(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3691based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3692RAM address would be the VMA.
3693
3694You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3695program with the @samp{-h} option.
3696
3697Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3698@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3699has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3700information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3701will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3702static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3703referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3704
3705You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3706program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3707option.
3708
3709@node Script Format
3710@section Linker Script Format
3711@cindex linker script format
3712Linker scripts are text files.
3713
3714You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3715either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3716symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3717generally ignored.
3718
3719Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3720If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3721otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3722double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3723file name.
3724
3725You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3726@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3727to whitespace.
3728
3729@node Simple Example
3730@section Simple Linker Script Example
3731@cindex linker script example
3732@cindex example of linker script
3733Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3734
3735The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3736@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3737memory layout of the output file.
3738
3739The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3740describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3741code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3742@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3743Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3744your input files.
3745
3746For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
37470x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3748linker script which will do that:
3749@smallexample
3750SECTIONS
3751@{
3752 . = 0x10000;
3753 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
3754 . = 0x8000000;
3755 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
3756 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
3757@}
3758@end smallexample
3759
3760You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
3761followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
3762descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
3763
252b5132
RH
3764The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
3765sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
3766counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
3767other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
3768current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
3769incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
3770@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
3771
3772The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
3773required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
3774after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
3775which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
3776wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
3777means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
3778
3779Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
3780@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
3781@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
3782
3783The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
3784the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
3785at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
3786output section, the value of the location counter will be
3787@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
3788effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 3789immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
3790
3791The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
3792alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
3793example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
3794sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
3795may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
3796sections.
3797
3798That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
3799
3800@node Simple Commands
3801@section Simple Linker Script Commands
3802@cindex linker script simple commands
3803In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
3804
3805@menu
3806* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
3807* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
3808@ifclear SingleFormat
3809* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
3810@end ifclear
3811
4a93e180 3812* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
3813* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
3814@end menu
3815
3816@node Entry Point
36f63dca 3817@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
3818@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3819@cindex start of execution
3820@cindex first instruction
3821@cindex entry point
3822The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
3823point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
3824entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
3825@smallexample
3826ENTRY(@var{symbol})
3827@end smallexample
3828
3829There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
3830entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
3831stopping when one of them succeeds:
3832@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 3833@item
252b5132 3834the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 3835@item
252b5132 3836the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 3837@item
a094d01f 3838the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 3839targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 3840check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 3841@item
252b5132 3842the address of the first byte of the @samp{.text} section, if present;
a1ab1d2a 3843@item
252b5132
RH
3844The address @code{0}.
3845@end itemize
3846
3847@node File Commands
36f63dca 3848@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
3849@cindex linker script file commands
3850Several linker script commands deal with files.
3851
3852@table @code
3853@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
3854@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
3855@cindex including a linker script
3856Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
3857be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 3858with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
385910 levels deep.
3860
4006703d
NS
3861You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
3862@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
3863
252b5132
RH
3864@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3865@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3866@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
3867@cindex input files in linker scripts
3868@cindex input object files in linker scripts
3869@cindex linker script input object files
3870The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
3871in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
3872
3873For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
3874a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
3875then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
3876
3877In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
3878script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
3879
e3f2db7f
AO
3880In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
3881with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
3882located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
3883for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
3884@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
3885filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
3886@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
3887
3888If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
3889the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
3890found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
3891not found the linker will search through the archive library search
3892path.
252b5132 3893
ff5dcc92 3894If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 3895name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
3896@samp{-l}.
3897
3898When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
3899files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
3900script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
3901
3902@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3903@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3904@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
3905@cindex grouping input files
3906The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
3907files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
3908new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 3909in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 3910
b717d30e
JJ
3911@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
3912@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
3913@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
3914This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
3915commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
3916as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
3917with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
3918when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
3919@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
3920and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
3921setting afterwards.
3922
252b5132
RH
3923@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
3924@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 3925@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
3926The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
3927@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
3928@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 3929Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
3930precedence.
3931
3932You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
3933output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
3934
3935@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3936@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
3937@cindex library search path in linker script
3938@cindex archive search path in linker script
3939@cindex search path in linker script
3940The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 3941@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 3942@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 3943on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 3944are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 3945the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
3946
3947@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
3948@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
3949@cindex first input file
3950The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
3951that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
3952though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
3953when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
3954first file.
3955@end table
3956
3957@ifclear SingleFormat
3958@node Format Commands
36f63dca 3959@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
3960A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
3961
3962@table @code
3963@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3964@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
3965@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
3966@cindex output file format in linker script
3967The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
3968output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 3969exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3970(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
3971line option takes precedence.
3972
3973You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 3974formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
3975This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
3976desired endianness.
3977
3978If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
3979will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
3980output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
3981used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
3982
3983For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
3984command:
3985@smallexample
3986OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
3987@end smallexample
3988This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 3989@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
3990option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
3991format.
3992
3993@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3994@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
3995@cindex input file format in linker script
3996The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
3997files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
3998This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 3999(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4000is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4001command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4002@end table
4003@end ifclear
4004
4a93e180
NC
4005@node REGION_ALIAS
4006@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4007@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4008@cindex region alias
4009@cindex region names
4010
4011Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4012@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4013
4014@smallexample
4015REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4016@end smallexample
4017
4018The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4019memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4020to memory regions. An example follows.
4021
4022Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4023memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4024that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4025non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4026access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4027read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4028sections:
4029
4030@itemize @bullet
4031@item
4032@code{.text} program code;
4033@item
4034@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4035@item
4036@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4037@item
4038@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4039@end itemize
4040
4041The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4042part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4043output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4044systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4045@code{C}:
4046@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4047@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4048@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4049@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4050@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4051@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4052@end multitable
4053The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4054loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4055the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4056the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4057
4058The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4059includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4060memory layout:
4061@smallexample
4062INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4063
4064SECTIONS
4065 @{
4066 .text :
4067 @{
4068 *(.text)
4069 @} > REGION_TEXT
4070 .rodata :
4071 @{
4072 *(.rodata)
4073 rodata_end = .;
4074 @} > REGION_RODATA
4075 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4076 @{
4077 data_start = .;
4078 *(.data)
4079 @} > REGION_DATA
4080 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4081 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4082 .bss :
4083 @{
4084 *(.bss)
4085 @} > REGION_BSS
4086 @}
4087@end smallexample
4088
4089Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4090regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4091variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4092@table @code
4093@item A
4094Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4095@smallexample
4096MEMORY
4097 @{
4098 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4099 @}
4100
4101REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4102REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4103REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4104REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4105@end smallexample
4106@item B
4107Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4108into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4109@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4110@smallexample
4111MEMORY
4112 @{
4113 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4114 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4115 @}
4116
4117REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4118REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4119REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4120REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4121@end smallexample
4122@item C
4123Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4124@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4125initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4126system start into the @code{RAM}.
4127@smallexample
4128MEMORY
4129 @{
4130 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4131 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4132 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4133 @}
4134
4135REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4136REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4137REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4138REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4139@end smallexample
4140@end table
4141
4142It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4143@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4144necessary:
4145@smallexample
4146#include <string.h>
4147
4148extern char data_start [];
4149extern char data_size [];
4150extern char data_load_start [];
4151
4152void copy_data(void)
4153@{
4154 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4155 @{
4156 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4157 @}
4158@}
4159@end smallexample
4160
252b5132 4161@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4162@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4163There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4164
4165@table @code
4166@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4167@kindex ASSERT
4168@cindex assertion in linker script
4169Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4170with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4171
fd1c4238
NC
4172Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4173take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4174inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4175for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4176symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4177
4178@smallexample
4179 .stack :
4180 @{
4181 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4182 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4183 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4184 @}
4185@end smallexample
4186
4187will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4188PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4189can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4190
4191@smallexample
4192 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4193 .stack :
4194 @{
4195 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4196 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4197 @}
4198@end smallexample
4199
4200will work.
4201
252b5132
RH
4202@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4203@kindex EXTERN
4204@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4205Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4206symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4207modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4208each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4209command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4210
4211@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4212@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4213@cindex common allocation in linker script
4214This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4215to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4216output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4217
4818e05f
AM
4218@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4219@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4220@cindex common allocation in linker script
4221This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4222command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4223to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4224
7bdf4127
AB
4225@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4226@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4227@cindex group allocation in linker script
4228@cindex section groups
4229@cindex COMDAT
4230This command has the same effect as the
4231@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4232@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4233and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4234specified (@samp{-r}).
4235
53d25da6
AM
4236@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4237@kindex INSERT
4238@cindex insert user script into default script
4239This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4240augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4241inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4242@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4243default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4244sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4245linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4246insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4247linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4248default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4249of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4250to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4251is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4252
4253@smallexample
4254SECTIONS
4255@{
4256 OVERLAY :
4257 @{
4258 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4259 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4260 @}
4261@}
4262INSERT AFTER .text;
4263@end smallexample
4264
252b5132
RH
4265@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4266@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4267@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4268This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4269references among certain output sections.
4270
4271In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4272using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4273will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4274errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4275a function defined in the other section.
4276
4277The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4278@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4279an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4280@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4281names.
4282
cdf96953
MF
4283@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4284@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4285@cindex cross references
4286This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4287references to one section from a list of other sections.
4288
4289The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4290output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4291a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4292there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4293must never call back.
4294
4295The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4296The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4297If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4298the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4299status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4300names, not input section names.
4301
252b5132
RH
4302@ifclear SingleFormat
4303@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4304@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4305@cindex machine architecture
4306@cindex architecture
4307Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4308of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4309architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4310the @samp{-f} option.
4311@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4312
4313@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4314@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4315This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4316@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4317in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4318@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4319@end table
4320
4321@node Assignments
4322@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4323@cindex assignment in scripts
4324@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4325@cindex variables, defining
4326You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4327the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4328
4329@menu
4330* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4331* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4332* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4333* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4334* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4335@end menu
4336
4337@node Simple Assignments
4338@subsection Simple Assignments
4339
4340You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4341
4342@table @code
4343@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4344@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4345@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4346@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4347@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4348@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4349@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4350@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4351@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4352@end table
4353
4354The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4355@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4356defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4357
4358The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4359may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4360
4361The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4362
4363Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4364
4365You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4366statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4367section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4368
4369The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4370expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4371
4372Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4373assignments may be used:
4374
4375@smallexample
4376floating_point = 0;
4377SECTIONS
4378@{
4379 .text :
4380 @{
4381 *(.text)
4382 _etext = .;
4383 @}
156e34dd 4384 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4385 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4386@}
4387@end smallexample
4388@noindent
4389In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4390zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4391the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4392defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4393upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4394
eb8476a6
MR
4395@node HIDDEN
4396@subsection HIDDEN
4397@cindex HIDDEN
4398For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4399exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4400
4401Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4402@code{HIDDEN}:
4403
4404@smallexample
4405HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4406SECTIONS
4407@{
4408 .text :
4409 @{
4410 *(.text)
4411 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4412 @}
4413 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4414 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4415@}
4416@end smallexample
4417@noindent
4418In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4419
252b5132
RH
4420@node PROVIDE
4421@subsection PROVIDE
4422@cindex PROVIDE
4423In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4424only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4425the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4426@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4427@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4428@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4429@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4430@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4431
4432Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4433@smallexample
4434SECTIONS
4435@{
4436 .text :
4437 @{
4438 *(.text)
4439 _etext = .;
4440 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4441 @}
4442@}
4443@end smallexample
4444
4445In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
4446underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition error. If, on
4447the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
4448underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4449If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4450linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4451
b0daac83
NC
4452Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4453defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4454that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4455when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4456@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4457
7af8e998
L
4458@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4459@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4460@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4461Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4462hidden and won't be exported.
4463
73ae6183
NC
4464@node Source Code Reference
4465@subsection Source Code Reference
4466
4467Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4468intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4469a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4470symbol that does not have a value.
4471
4472Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4473transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4474stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4475prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4476mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4477of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4478variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4479linker script variable might be referred to as:
4480
4481@smallexample
4482 extern int foo;
4483@end smallexample
4484
4485But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4486
4487@smallexample
4488 _foo = 1000;
4489@end smallexample
4490
4491In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4492transformation has taken place.
4493
4494When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4495things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4496in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4497second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4498table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4499contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4500value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4501
4502@smallexample
4503 int foo = 1000;
4504@end smallexample
4505
10bf6894 4506creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4507holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4508number 1000 is initially stored.
4509
4510When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4511first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4512memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4513So:
4514
4515@smallexample
4516 foo = 1;
4517@end smallexample
4518
4519looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4520associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4521address. Whereas:
4522
4523@smallexample
4524 int * a = & foo;
4525@end smallexample
4526
10bf6894 4527looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4528and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4529the variable @samp{a}.
4530
4531Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4532the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4533an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4534
4535@smallexample
4536 foo = 1000;
4537@end smallexample
4538
4539creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4540the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4541address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4542linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4543access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4544
4545Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4546you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4547use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4548section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4549linker script contains these declarations:
4550
4551@smallexample
4552@group
4553 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4554 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4555 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4556@end group
4557@end smallexample
4558
4559Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4560
4561@smallexample
4562@group
4563 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4564
73ae6183
NC
4565 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4566@end group
4567@end smallexample
4568
4569Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4570Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4571arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4572
4573@smallexample
4574@group
4575 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4576
4577 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4578@end group
4579@end smallexample
4580
4581Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4582operators.
73ae6183 4583
252b5132 4584@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4585@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4586@kindex SECTIONS
4587The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4588into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4589
4590The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4591@smallexample
4592SECTIONS
4593@{
4594 @var{sections-command}
4595 @var{sections-command}
4596 @dots{}
4597@}
4598@end smallexample
4599
4600Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4601
4602@itemize @bullet
4603@item
4604an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4605@item
4606a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4607@item
4608an output section description
4609@item
4610an overlay description
4611@end itemize
4612
4613The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4614@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4615those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4616understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4617the layout of the output file.
4618
4619Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4620below.
4621
4622If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4623linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4624section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4625input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4626example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4627in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4628
4629@menu
4630* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4631* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4632* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4633* Input Section:: Input section description
4634* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4635* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4636* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4637* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4638* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4639@end menu
4640
4641@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4642@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4643The full description of an output section looks like this:
4644@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4645@group
7e7d5768 4646@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4647 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4648 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4649 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4650 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4651 @{
4652 @var{output-section-command}
4653 @var{output-section-command}
4654 @dots{}
abc9061b 4655 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4656@end group
4657@end smallexample
4658
4659Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4660
4661The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4662name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4663The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4664the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4665The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4666
4667Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4668
4669@itemize @bullet
4670@item
4671a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4672@item
4673an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4674@item
4675data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4676@item
4677a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4678@end itemize
4679
4680@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4681@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4682@cindex name, section
4683@cindex section name
4684The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4685meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4686support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4687must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4688example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4689output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4690names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4691quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4692characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4693commas must be quoted.
4694
4695The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4696Discarding}.
4697
4698@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4699@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4700@cindex address, section
4701@cindex section address
4702The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4703address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4704is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4705
4706If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4707section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4708to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4709alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4710contained within the output section.
4711
4712The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4713
4714@itemize @bullet
4715@item
4716If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4717is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4718in that region.
4719
4720@item
4721If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4722regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4723section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4724be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4725
4726@item
4727If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4728the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4729counter.
4730@end itemize
4731
4732@noindent
4733For example:
4734
252b5132
RH
4735@smallexample
4736.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4737@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4738
252b5132
RH
4739@noindent
4740and
ea5cae92 4741
252b5132
RH
4742@smallexample
4743.text : @{ *(.text) @}
4744@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4745
252b5132
RH
4746@noindent
4747are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
4748@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
4749counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
4750counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
4751input sections.
252b5132
RH
4752
4753The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
4754For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
4755so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
4756do something like this:
4757@smallexample
4758.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
4759@end smallexample
4760@noindent
4761This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
4762aligned upward to the specified value.
4763
4764Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
4765location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
4766sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
4767
4768@node Input Section
36f63dca 4769@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
4770@cindex input sections
4771@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
4772The most common output section command is an input section description.
4773
4774The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
4775You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
4776in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
4777map the input files into your memory layout.
4778
4779@menu
4780* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
4781* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
4782* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
4783* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
4784* Input Section Example:: Input section example
4785@end menu
4786
4787@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 4788@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
4789@cindex input section basics
4790An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
4791by a list of section names in parentheses.
4792
4793The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
4794describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
4795
4796The most common input section description is to include all input
4797sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
4798include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
4799@smallexample
4800*(.text)
4801@end smallexample
4802@noindent
18625d54 4803Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 4804@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
4805of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
4806match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
4807example:
252b5132 4808@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4809EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
4810@end smallexample
4811@noindent
4812will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
4813and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
4814placed inside the section list, for example:
4815@smallexample
b4346c09 4816*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 4817@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4818@noindent
4819The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
4820two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
4821more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
4822
4823There are two ways to include more than one section:
4824@smallexample
4825*(.text .rdata)
4826*(.text) *(.rdata)
4827@end smallexample
4828@noindent
4829The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
4830@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
4831first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
4832they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
4833@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
4834@samp{.rdata} input sections.
4835
8f1732fc
AB
4836When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
4837is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
4838immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4839@smallexample
4840*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
4841@end smallexample
4842@noindent
4843will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
4844@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
4845from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
4846exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 4847could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
4848@smallexample
4849*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
4850@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
4851@noindent
4852Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
4853before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
4854all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
4855@smallexample
4856EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
4857@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 4858
252b5132
RH
4859You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
4860You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
4861needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
4862@smallexample
4863data.o(.data)
4864@end smallexample
4865
ae17ab41
CM
4866To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
4867of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
4868
4869Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
4870
4871@smallexample
4872@group
4873SECTIONS @{
4874 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
4875 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
4876@}
4877@end group
4878@end smallexample
4879
4880In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
4881input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
4882@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
4883@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
4884whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
4885
967928e9
AM
4886You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
4887matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
4888with no whitespace around the colon.
4889
4890@table @samp
4891@item archive:file
4892matches file within archive
4893@item archive:
4894matches the whole archive
4895@item :file
4896matches file but not one in an archive
4897@end table
4898
4899Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
4900wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
4901single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
4902@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
4903within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
4904also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
4905other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
4906from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
4907command.
4908
252b5132
RH
4909If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
4910the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
4911commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
4912@smallexample
4913data.o
4914@end smallexample
4915
967928e9
AM
4916When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
4917and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
4918characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
4919name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
4920did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
4921though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
4922@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
4923the archive search path.
4924
4925@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 4926@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
4927@cindex input section wildcards
4928@cindex wildcard file name patterns
4929@cindex file name wildcard patterns
4930@cindex section name wildcard patterns
4931In an input section description, either the file name or the section
4932name or both may be wildcard patterns.
4933
4934The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
4935pattern for the file name.
4936
4937The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
4938
4939@table @samp
4940@item *
4941matches any number of characters
4942@item ?
4943matches any single character
4944@item [@var{chars}]
4945matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
4946character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
4947@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
4948@item \
4949quotes the following character
4950@end table
4951
4952When a file name is matched with a wildcard, the wildcard characters
4953will not match a @samp{/} character (used to separate directory names on
4954Unix). A pattern consisting of a single @samp{*} character is an
4955exception; it will always match any file name, whether it contains a
4956@samp{/} or not. In a section name, the wildcard characters will match
4957a @samp{/} character.
4958
4959File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
4960specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
4961does not search directories to expand wildcards.
4962
4963If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
4964appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
4965will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
4966sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
4967@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
4968@smallexample
4969.data : @{ *(.data) @}
4970.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
4971@end smallexample
4972
bcaa7b3e 4973@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
4974Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
4975in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
4976this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
4977pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
4978@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
4979into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
4980
bcaa7b3e 4981@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
4982@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4983@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
4984alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
4985alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
4986needed.
bcaa7b3e 4987
02ecc8e9 4988@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
4989@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4990@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
4991numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
4992section name before placing them in the output file. In
4993@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
4994the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
4995@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 4996
bcaa7b3e
L
4997@cindex SORT
4998@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
4999
5000When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5001can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5002
5003@enumerate
5004@item
5005@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5006It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5007sections have the same name.
5008@item
5009@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5010It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5011sections have the same alignment.
5012@item
c0065db7 5013@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5014treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5015@item
5016@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5017is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5018@item
5019All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5020@end enumerate
5021
a05a5b64 5022When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5023section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5024takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5025
5026If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5027command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5028treated as nested sorting command.
5029
5030@enumerate
5031@item
5032@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5033@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5034@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5035@item
5036@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5037@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5038@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5039@end enumerate
5040
5041If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5042command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5043
eda680f8 5044@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5045@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5046section sorting option.
5047
252b5132
RH
5048If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5049@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5050precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5051
5052This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5053files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5054sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5055The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5056with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5057linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5058@smallexample
5059@group
5060SECTIONS @{
5061 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5062 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5063 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5064 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5065@}
5066@end group
5067@end smallexample
5068
5069@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5070@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5071@cindex common symbol placement
5072@cindex uninitialized data placement
5073A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5074file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5075linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5076named @samp{COMMON}.
5077
5078You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5079other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5080particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5081input files are placed in another section.
5082
5083In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5084@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5085@smallexample
5086.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5087@end smallexample
5088
5089@cindex scommon section
5090@cindex small common symbols
5091Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5092example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5093symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5094different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5095the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5096symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5097to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5098locations.
5099
5100@cindex [COMMON]
5101You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5102notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5103@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5104
5105@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5106@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5107@cindex KEEP
5108@cindex garbage collection
5109When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5110it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5111This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5112with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5113@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5114
5115@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5116@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5117The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5118to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5119start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5120@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5121follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5122@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5123@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5124All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5125files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5126
5127@smallexample
5128@group
5129SECTIONS @{
5130 outputa 0x10000 :
5131 @{
5132 all.o
5133 foo.o (.input1)
5134 @}
36f63dca
NC
5135@end group
5136@group
252b5132
RH
5137 outputb :
5138 @{
5139 foo.o (.input2)
5140 foo1.o (.input1)
5141 @}
36f63dca
NC
5142@end group
5143@group
252b5132
RH
5144 outputc :
5145 @{
5146 *(.input1)
5147 *(.input2)
5148 @}
5149@}
5150@end group
a1ab1d2a 5151@end smallexample
252b5132 5152
cbd0eecf
L
5153If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5154and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5155automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5156__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5157indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5158respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5159C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
5160
252b5132 5161@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5162@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5163@cindex data
5164@cindex section data
5165@cindex output section data
5166@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5167@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5168@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5169@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5170@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5171You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5172@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5173an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5174parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5175value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5176counter.
5177
5178The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5179store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5180bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5181stored.
5182
5183For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5184of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5185@smallexample
5186BYTE(1)
5187LONG(addr)
5188@end smallexample
5189
5190When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5191same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5192target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5193@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5194@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5195
5196If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5197which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5198When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5199true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5200endianness of the first input object file.
5201
36f63dca 5202Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5203between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5204@smallexample
5205SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5206@end smallexample
5207whereas this will work:
5208@smallexample
5209SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5210@end smallexample
5211
252b5132
RH
5212@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5213@cindex holes, filling
5214@cindex unspecified memory
5215You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5216current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5217otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5218gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5219with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5220necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5221point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5222than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5223different parts of an output section.
5224
5225This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5226value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5227@smallexample
563e308f 5228FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5229@end smallexample
5230
5231The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5232section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5233part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5234entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5235precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5236expression.
252b5132
RH
5237
5238@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5239@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5240There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5241commands.
5242
5243@table @code
5244@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5245@cindex input filename symbols
5246@cindex filename symbols
5247@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5248The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5249The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5250file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5251the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5252
5253This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5254normally used for any other object file format.
5255
5256@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5257@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5258@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5259@item CONSTRUCTORS
5260When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5261unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5262destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5263arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5264automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5265For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5266linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5267@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5268ignored for other object file formats.
5269
5270The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5271constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5272Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5273the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5274first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5275of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5276compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5277formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5278@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5279the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5280destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5281@code{exit}.
5282
5283For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5284arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5285addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5286and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5287linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5288runtime code expects to see.
5289
5290@smallexample
5291 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5292 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5293 *(.ctors)
5294 LONG(0)
5295 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5296 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5297 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5298 *(.dtors)
5299 LONG(0)
5300 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5301@end smallexample
5302
5303If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5304which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5305are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5306are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5307command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5308@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5309@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5310@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5311
5312Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5313and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5314need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5315scripts.
5316
5317@end table
5318
5319@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5320@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5321@cindex discarding sections
5322@cindex sections, discarding
5323@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5324The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5325This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5326may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5327@smallexample
49c13adb 5328.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5329@end smallexample
5330@noindent
5331will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5332@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5333sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5334space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5335too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5336space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5337@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5338@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5339This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5340
a0976ea4 5341The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5342on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5343symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5344the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5345section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5346
5347@cindex /DISCARD/
5348The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5349input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5350section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5351
99fabbc9
JL
5352This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5353@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5354garbage collection.
5355
a2e098c3
NC
5356Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5357discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5358members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5359Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5360
252b5132 5361@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5362@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5363@cindex output section attributes
5364We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5365like this:
0c71d759 5366
252b5132 5367@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5368@group
7e7d5768 5369@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5370 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5371 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5372 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5373 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5374 @{
5375 @var{output-section-command}
5376 @var{output-section-command}
5377 @dots{}
562d3460 5378 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5379@end group
5380@end smallexample
0c71d759 5381
252b5132
RH
5382We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5383@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5384remaining section attributes.
5385
a1ab1d2a 5386@menu
252b5132
RH
5387* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5388* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5389* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5390* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5391* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5392* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5393* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5394* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5395@end menu
5396
5397@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5398@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5399Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5400parentheses. The following types are defined:
5401
5402@table @code
5403@item NOLOAD
5404The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5405loaded into memory when the program is run.
5406@item DSECT
5407@itemx COPY
5408@itemx INFO
5409@itemx OVERLAY
5410These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5411rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5412marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5413section when the program is run.
5414@end table
5415
5416@kindex NOLOAD
5417@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5418@cindex loading, preventing
5419The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5420the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5421the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5422@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5423need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5424@smallexample
5425@group
5426SECTIONS @{
5427 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5428 @dots{}
5429@}
5430@end group
5431@end smallexample
5432
5433@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5434@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5435@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5436@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5437@cindex load address
5438@cindex section load address
5439Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5440@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5441@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5442specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5443address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5444
ea5cae92
NC
5445The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5446specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5447takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5448load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5449region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5450
5451If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5452section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5453load address:
5454
5455@itemize @bullet
5456@item
5457If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5458the LMA address as well.
5459
5460@item
5461If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5462
5463@item
5464Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5465with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5466section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5467VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5468the last section in the located region.
5469
5470@item
5471If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5472that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5473
5474@item
5475If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5476section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5477@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5478
5479@cindex ROM initialized data
5480@cindex initialized data in ROM
5481This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5482example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5483called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5484@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5485even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5486uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5487defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5488counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5489
5490@smallexample
5491@group
5492SECTIONS
5493 @{
5494 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5495 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5496 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5497 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5498 .bss 0x3000 :
5499 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5500@}
5501@end group
5502@end smallexample
5503
5504The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5505this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5506the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5507how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5508script.
5509
5510@smallexample
5511@group
5512extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5513char *src = &_etext;
5514char *dst = &_data;
5515
ea5cae92
NC
5516/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5517while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5518 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5519
ea5cae92 5520/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5521for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5522 *dst = 0;
5523@end group
5524@end smallexample
5525
bbf115d3
L
5526@node Forced Output Alignment
5527@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5528@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5529@cindex forcing output section alignment
5530@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5531You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5532alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5533intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5534
7e7d5768
AM
5535@node Forced Input Alignment
5536@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5537@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5538@cindex forcing input section alignment
5539@cindex input section alignment
5540You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5541SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5542sections, whether larger or smaller.
5543
0c71d759
NC
5544@node Output Section Constraint
5545@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5546@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5547@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5548@cindex constraints on output sections
5549You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5550of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5551read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5552@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5553
252b5132 5554@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5555@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5556@kindex >@var{region}
5557@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5558@cindex memory regions and sections
5559You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5560using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5561
5562Here is a simple example:
5563@smallexample
5564@group
5565MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5566SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5567@end group
5568@end smallexample
5569
5570@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5571@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5572@kindex :@var{phdr}
5573@cindex section, assigning to program header
5574@cindex program headers and sections
5575You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5576using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5577one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5578assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5579@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5580linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5581
5582Here is a simple example:
5583@smallexample
5584@group
5585PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5586SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5587@end group
5588@end smallexample
5589
5590@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5591@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5592@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5593@cindex section fill pattern
5594@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5595You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5596@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5597(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5598within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5599alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5600necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5601of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5602an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5603fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5604other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5605pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5606expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5607
5608You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5609output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5610
5611Here is a simple example:
5612@smallexample
5613@group
563e308f 5614SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5615@end group
5616@end smallexample
5617
5618@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5619@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5620@kindex OVERLAY
5621@cindex overlays
5622An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5623are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5624the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5625copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5626required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5627can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5628than another.
5629
5630Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5631@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5632output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5633command is as follows:
5634@smallexample
5635@group
5636OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5637 @{
5638 @var{secname1}
5639 @{
5640 @var{output-section-command}
5641 @var{output-section-command}
5642 @dots{}
5643 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5644 @var{secname2}
5645 @{
5646 @var{output-section-command}
5647 @var{output-section-command}
5648 @dots{}
5649 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5650 @dots{}
abc9061b 5651 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5652@end group
5653@end smallexample
5654
5655Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5656section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5657section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5658those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5659except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5660sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5661
abc9061b
CC
5662The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5663the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5664
252b5132
RH
5665The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5666addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5667memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5668whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5669and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5670and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5671
56dd11f0
NC
5672If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5673references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5674the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5675sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5676@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5677
5678For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5679provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5680defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5681@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5682the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5683within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5684symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5685
5686At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5687the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5688
5689Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5690@code{SECTIONS} construct.
5691@smallexample
5692@group
5693 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
5694 @{
5695 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
5696 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
5697 @}
5698@end group
5699@end smallexample
5700@noindent
5701This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
5702address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
5703@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 5704following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
5705@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
5706@code{__load_stop_text1}.
5707
5708C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
5709like the following.
5710
5711@smallexample
5712@group
5713 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
5714 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
5715 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
5716@end group
5717@end smallexample
5718
5719Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
5720everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
5721example could have been written identically as follows.
5722
5723@smallexample
5724@group
5725 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5726 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
5727 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 5728 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
5729 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
5730 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
5731 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
5732@end group
5733@end smallexample
5734
5735@node MEMORY
36f63dca 5736@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
5737@kindex MEMORY
5738@cindex memory regions
5739@cindex regions of memory
5740@cindex allocating memory
5741@cindex discontinuous memory
5742The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
5743memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
5744
5745The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
5746memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
5747may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
5748can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
5749set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
5750regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
5751around to fit into the available regions.
5752
127fcdff
AB
5753A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
5754however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
5755specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
5756@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
5757@smallexample
5758@group
a1ab1d2a 5759MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5760 @{
5761 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
5762 @dots{}
5763 @}
5764@end group
5765@end smallexample
5766
5767The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
5768region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
5769Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5770with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
5771must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
5772add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 5773command.
252b5132
RH
5774
5775@cindex memory region attributes
5776The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
5777whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
5778not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
5779@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
5780section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
5781the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
5782them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
5783
5784The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
5785@table @samp
5786@item R
5787Read-only section
5788@item W
5789Read/write section
5790@item X
5791Executable section
5792@item A
5793Allocatable section
5794@item I
5795Initialized section
5796@item L
5797Same as @samp{I}
5798@item !
c09e9a8c 5799Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
5800@end table
5801
81c688d5 5802If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 5803@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
5804attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
5805unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
5806not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
5807string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
5808or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
5809the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
5810
5811@kindex ORIGIN =
5812@kindex o =
5813@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
5814The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
5815the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
5816cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
5817abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
5818@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
5819
5820@kindex LENGTH =
5821@kindex len =
5822@kindex l =
5823The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
5824region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
5825be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
5826@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
5827
5828In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
5829available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
5830and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
5831linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
5832is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
5833or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
5834explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
5835region.
5836
5837@smallexample
5838@group
a1ab1d2a 5839MEMORY
252b5132
RH
5840 @{
5841 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
5842 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
5843 @}
5844@end group
5845@end smallexample
5846
5847Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
5848specific output sections into that memory region by using the
5849@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
5850a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
5851output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
5852was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
5853the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
5854output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
5855region, the linker will issue an error message.
5856
3ec57632 5857It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 5858expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
5859@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
5860
5861@smallexample
5862@group
c0065db7 5863 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
5864@end group
5865@end smallexample
5866
252b5132
RH
5867@node PHDRS
5868@section PHDRS Command
5869@kindex PHDRS
5870@cindex program headers
5871@cindex ELF program headers
5872@cindex program segments
5873@cindex segments, ELF
5874The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
5875@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
5876loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
5877program with the @samp{-p} option.
5878
5879When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
5880reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
5881program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
5882This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
5883interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
5884
5885The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
5886in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
5887precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
5888the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
5889not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
5890
5891The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
5892generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
5893ignore @code{PHDRS}.
5894
5895This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
5896@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
5897
5898@smallexample
5899@group
5900PHDRS
5901@{
5902 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
5903 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
5904@}
5905@end group
5906@end smallexample
5907
5908The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
5909of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
5910header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
5911with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
5912must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
5913is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
5914
5915Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
5916system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
5917specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
5918sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
5919attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
5920Section Phdr}.
5921
5922It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
5923merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
5924repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
5925contain the section.
5926
5927If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
5928then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
5929not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
5930convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
5931placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
5932default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
5933segment at all.
5934
5935@kindex FILEHDR
5936@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 5937You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
5938the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
5939The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
5940file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 5941include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
5942segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
5943these keywords.
252b5132
RH
5944
5945The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
5946value of the keyword.
5947
5948@table @asis
5949@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
5950Indicates an unused program header.
5951
5952@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
5953Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
5954the file.
5955
5956@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
5957Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
5958
5959@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
5960Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
5961found.
5962
5963@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
5964Indicates a segment holding note information.
5965
5966@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
5967A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
5968ABI.
5969
5970@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
5971Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
5972
1a9ccd70
NC
5973@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
5974Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
5975
252b5132
RH
5976@item @var{expression}
5977An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
5978be used for types not defined above.
5979@end table
5980
5981You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
5982in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
5983@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
5984Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
5985output section attribute.
5986
5987The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
5988which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
5989explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
5990an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
5991header.
5992
5993Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
5994headers used on a native ELF system.
5995
5996@example
5997@group
5998PHDRS
5999@{
6000 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6001 interp PT_INTERP ;
6002 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6003 data PT_LOAD ;
6004 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6005@}
6006
6007SECTIONS
6008@{
6009 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6010 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6011 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6012 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6013 @dots{}
6014 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6015 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6016 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6017 @dots{}
6018@}
6019@end group
6020@end example
6021
6022@node VERSION
6023@section VERSION Command
6024@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6025@cindex symbol versions
6026@cindex version script
6027@cindex versions of symbols
6028The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6029only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6030symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6031a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6032shared library.
6033
6034You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6035you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6036also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6037
6038The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6039@smallexample
6040VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6041@end smallexample
6042
6043The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6044Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6045version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6046version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6047version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6048scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6049library.
6050
6051The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6052examples.
6053
6054@smallexample
6055VERS_1.1 @{
6056 global:
6057 foo1;
6058 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6059 old*;
6060 original*;
6061 new*;
252b5132
RH
6062@};
6063
6064VERS_1.2 @{
6065 foo2;
6066@} VERS_1.1;
6067
6068VERS_2.0 @{
6069 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6070 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6071 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6072 "f(int, double)";
6073 @};
252b5132
RH
6074@} VERS_1.2;
6075@end smallexample
6076
6077This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6078version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6079The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6080a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6081of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6082symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6083is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6084in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6085However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6086name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6087
6088Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6089depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6090to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6091
6092Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6093depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6094and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6095
6096When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6097specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6098unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6099unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6100somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6101wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6102wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6103set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6104ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6105
6106The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6107they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6108could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6109However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6110
0f6bf451 6111Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6112in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6113symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6114won't.
6115
6116@smallexample
7c9c73be 6117@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6118@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6119
252b5132
RH
6120When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6121symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6122requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6123shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6124loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6125linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6126application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6127way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6128all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6129search for each symbol reference.
6130
6131The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6132doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6133that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6134functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6135the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6136required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6137that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6138versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6139the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6140
6141There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6142first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6143source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6144script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6145maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6146@smallexample
6147__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6148@end smallexample
6149@noindent
6150in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6151be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6152The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6153@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6154takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6155
6156The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6157function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6158an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6159version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6160linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6161
6162To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6163source file. Here is an example:
6164
6165@smallexample
6166__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6167__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6168__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6169__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6170@end smallexample
6171
6172In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6173unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6174example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6175@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6176
6177When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6178some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6179this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6180@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6181declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6182you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6183
6184If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6185within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6186(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6187specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6188
cb840a31
L
6189You can also specify the language in the version script:
6190
6191@smallexample
6192VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6193@end smallexample
6194
c0065db7 6195The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6196The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6197demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6198patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6199@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6200
86043bbb
MM
6201Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6202described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6203or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6204the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6205whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6206cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6207might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6208should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6209expect when you upgrade.
6210
252b5132
RH
6211@node Expressions
6212@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6213@cindex expressions
6214@cindex arithmetic
6215The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
6216that of C expressions. All expressions are evaluated as integers. All
6217expressions are evaluated in the same size, which is 32 bits if both the
6218host and target are 32 bits, and is otherwise 64 bits.
6219
6220You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6221
6222The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6223expressions.
6224
6225@menu
6226* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6227* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6228* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6229* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6230* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6231* Operators:: Operators
6232* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6233* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6234* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6235@end menu
6236
6237@node Constants
6238@subsection Constants
6239@cindex integer notation
6240@cindex constants in linker scripts
6241All constants are integers.
6242
6243As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6244octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6245hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6246@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6247@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6248value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6249
6250@cindex scaled integers
6251@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6252@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6253@cindex suffixes for integers
6254@cindex integer suffixes
6255In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6256constant by
6257@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6258@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6259@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6260@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6261@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6262@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6263@tex
6264${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6265@end tex
6266@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6267respectively. For example, the following
6268all refer to the same quantity:
6269
252b5132 6270@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6271_fourk_1 = 4K;
6272_fourk_2 = 4096;
6273_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6274_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6275@end smallexample
6276
8a308ae8
NC
6277Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6278conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6279
0c71d759
NC
6280@node Symbolic Constants
6281@subsection Symbolic Constants
6282@cindex symbolic constants
6283@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6284It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6285the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6286
6287@table @code
6288@item MAXPAGESIZE
6289@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6290The target's maximum page size.
6291
6292@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6293@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6294The target's default page size.
6295@end table
6296
6297So for example:
6298
6299@smallexample
9d5777a3 6300 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6301@end smallexample
6302
6303will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6304supported by the target.
6305
252b5132
RH
6306@node Symbols
6307@subsection Symbol Names
6308@cindex symbol names
6309@cindex names
6310@cindex quoted symbol names
6311@kindex "
6312Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6313and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6314Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6315specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6316keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6317@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6318"SECTION" = 9;
6319"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6320@end smallexample
6321
6322Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6323to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6324whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6325
ecca9871
L
6326@node Orphan Sections
6327@subsection Orphan Sections
6328@cindex orphan
6329Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6330are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6331script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6332output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6333in which to place the orphaned input section.
6334
6335If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6336an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6337placed at the end of that output section.
6338
6339If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6340sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6341name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6342orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6343one new output section.
6344
6345If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6346then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6347in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6348linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6349attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6350sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6351support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6352
a05a5b64
TP
6353The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6354(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6355output sections an orphan is placed in.
6356
252b5132
RH
6357@node Location Counter
6358@subsection The Location Counter
6359@kindex .
6360@cindex dot
6361@cindex location counter
6362@cindex current output location
6363The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6364current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6365location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6366within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6367anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6368
6369@cindex holes
6370Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6371moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6372location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6373and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6374doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6375
6376@smallexample
6377SECTIONS
6378@{
6379 output :
6380 @{
6381 file1(.text)
6382 . = . + 1000;
6383 file2(.text)
6384 . += 1000;
6385 file3(.text)
563e308f 6386 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6387@}
6388@end smallexample
6389@noindent
6390In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6391located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6392followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6393@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6394@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6395specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6396
5c6bbab8
NC
6397@cindex dot inside sections
6398Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6399current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6400statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6401absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6402however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6403not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6404
6405@smallexample
6406SECTIONS
6407@{
6408 . = 0x100
6409 .text: @{
6410 *(.text)
6411 . = 0x200
6412 @}
6413 . = 0x500
6414 .data: @{
6415 *(.data)
6416 . += 0x600
6417 @}
6418@}
6419@end smallexample
6420
6421The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6422and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6423the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6424much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6425move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6426and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6427the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6428the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6429
b5666f2f
AM
6430@cindex dot outside sections
6431Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6432output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6433needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6434
6435@smallexample
6436SECTIONS
6437@{
6438 start_of_text = . ;
6439 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6440 end_of_text = . ;
6441
6442 start_of_data = . ;
6443 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6444 end_of_data = . ;
6445@}
6446@end smallexample
6447
6448If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6449not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6450between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6451should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6452blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6453the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6454sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6455statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6456special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6457place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6458as follows:
6459
6460@smallexample
6461SECTIONS
6462@{
6463 start_of_text = . ;
6464 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6465 end_of_text = . ;
6466
6467 start_of_data = . ;
6468 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6469 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6470 end_of_data = . ;
6471@}
6472@end smallexample
6473
6474This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6475@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6476placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6477assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6478a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6479section. So you could write:
6480
6481@smallexample
6482SECTIONS
6483@{
6484 start_of_text = . ;
6485 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6486 end_of_text = . ;
6487
6488 . = . ;
6489 start_of_data = . ;
6490 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6491 end_of_data = . ;
6492@}
6493@end smallexample
6494
6495Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6496@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6497
252b5132
RH
6498@need 2000
6499@node Operators
6500@subsection Operators
6501@cindex operators for arithmetic
6502@cindex arithmetic operators
6503@cindex precedence in expressions
6504The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6505the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6506@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6507@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6508@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6509@smallexample
6510precedence associativity Operators Notes
6511(highest)
65121 left ! - ~ (1)
65132 left * / %
65143 left + -
65154 left >> <<
65165 left == != > < <= >=
65176 left &
65187 left |
65198 left &&
65209 left ||
652110 right ? :
652211 right &= += -= *= /= (2)
6523(lowest)
6524@end smallexample
6525Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6526(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6527(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6528@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6529@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6530@tex
6531\vskip \baselineskip
6532%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6533\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6534\hrule
6535\halign
6536{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6537height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6538&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6539height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6540\noalign{\hrule}
6541height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6542&highest&&&&&\cr
6543% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6544&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6545&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6546&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6547&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
6548&5&&left&&== != > < <= >=&\cr
6549&6&&left&&\&&\cr
6550&7&&left&&|&\cr
6551&8&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6552&9&&left&&||&\cr
6553&10&&right&&? :&\cr
6554&11&&right&&\qquad\&= += -= *= /=\qquad\ddag&\cr
6555&lowest&&&&&\cr
6556height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6557\hrule}
6558@end tex
6559@iftex
6560{
6561@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6562@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6563@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6564}
6565@end iftex
6566@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6567
6568@node Evaluation
6569@subsection Evaluation
6570@cindex lazy evaluation
6571@cindex expression evaluation order
6572The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6573an expression when absolutely necessary.
6574
6575The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6576address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6577regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6578as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6579
6580However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6581until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6582other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6583for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6584
6585The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6586assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6587allocation.
6588
6589Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6590@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6591
6592If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6593available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6594following
6595@smallexample
6596@group
6597SECTIONS
6598 @{
a1ab1d2a 6599 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6600 @{ *(.text) @}
6601 @}
6602@end group
6603@end smallexample
6604@noindent
6605will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6606address}.
6607
6608@node Expression Section
6609@subsection The Section of an Expression
6610@cindex expression sections
6611@cindex absolute expressions
6612@cindex relative expressions
6613@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6614@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6615@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6616Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6617relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6618using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6619value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6620symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6621operations.
6622
abf4be64
AM
6623Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6624section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6625address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6626@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6627functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6628One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6629(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6630differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6631versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6632section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6633Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6634absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6635given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6636everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6637
6638In the following simple example,
252b5132 6639
7542af2a
AM
6640@smallexample
6641@group
6642SECTIONS
6643 @{
6644 . = 0x100;
6645 __executable_start = 0x100;
6646 .data :
6647 @{
6648 . = 0x10;
6649 __data_start = 0x10;
6650 *(.data)
6651 @}
6652 @dots{}
6653 @}
6654@end group
6655@end smallexample
252b5132 6656
7542af2a
AM
6657both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6658address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6659@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6660section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6661
5c3049d2
AM
6662For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6663addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6664
6665@itemize @bullet
6666@item
c05f749e
AM
6667Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6668operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6669absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6670@item
7542af2a
AM
6671Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6672relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6673and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6674@item
c05f749e
AM
6675Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6676in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6677address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6678before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6679@end itemize
6680
6681The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6682
6683@itemize @bullet
6684@item
6685An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
6686@item
6687The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
6688@item
9bc8bb33 6689The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 6690relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
6691(after above conversions) is also a number when
6692@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
6693but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
6694@item
6695The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
6696relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
6697section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
6698@item
6699The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
6700conversions) is an absolute address.
6701@end itemize
252b5132
RH
6702
6703You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
6704to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
6705create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
6706section @samp{.data}:
6707@smallexample
6708SECTIONS
6709 @{
6710 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
6711 @}
6712@end smallexample
6713@noindent
6714If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
6715@samp{.data} section.
6716
7542af2a
AM
6717Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
6718particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
6719
252b5132
RH
6720@node Builtin Functions
6721@subsection Builtin Functions
6722@cindex functions in expressions
6723The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
6724use in linker script expressions.
6725
6726@table @code
6727@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6728@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
6729@cindex expression, absolute
6730Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
6731of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
6732value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
6733normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
6734
6735@item ADDR(@var{section})
6736@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
6737@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 6738Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 6739script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
6740the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
6741@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
6742@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
6743the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
6744@smallexample
6745@group
6746SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6747 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 6748 @{
252b5132
RH
6749 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
6750 @dots{}
6751 @}
6752 .output :
6753 @{
6754 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
6755 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
6756 @}
6757@dots{} @}
6758@end group
6759@end smallexample
6760
876f4090
NS
6761@item ALIGN(@var{align})
6762@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
6763@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
6764@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
6765@cindex round up location counter
6766@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
6767@cindex round up expression
6768@cindex align expression
6769Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
6770to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
6771doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
6772arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
6773expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 6774equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
6775
6776Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
6777next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
6778variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
6779input sections:
252b5132
RH
6780@smallexample
6781@group
6782SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6783 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
6784 *(.data)
6785 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
6786 @}
6787@dots{} @}
6788@end group
6789@end smallexample
6790@noindent
6791The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
6792a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
6793a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
6794of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
6795
6796The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
6797
362c1d1a
NS
6798@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6799@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
6800@cindex section alignment
6801Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6802been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6803evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6804the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the first
6805value in that section.
6806@smallexample
6807@group
6808SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6809 .output @{
6810 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
6811 @dots{}
6812 @}
6813@dots{} @}
6814@end group
6815@end smallexample
6816
252b5132
RH
6817@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
6818@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
6819This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
6820scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
6821section.
6822
2d20f7bf
JJ
6823@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6824@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
6825This is equivalent to either
6826@smallexample
6827(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
6828@end smallexample
6829or
6830@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
6831(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
6832 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
6833@end smallexample
6834@noindent
6835depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
6836for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
6837@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
6838If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
6839memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
6840bytes in the on-disk file.
6841
6842This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
6843any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
6844@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
6845be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
6846running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
6847that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
6848page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
6849
6850@noindent
6851Example:
6852@smallexample
6853 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
6854@end smallexample
6855
6856@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6857@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
6858This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
6859evaluation purposes.
6860
6861@smallexample
6862 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
6863@end smallexample
6864
a4f5ad88
JJ
6865@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6866@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
6867This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 6868@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6869When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
6870does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
6871@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
6872argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
6873script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
6874@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
6875padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
6876section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
6877
6878@smallexample
6879 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
6880@end smallexample
6881
252b5132
RH
6882@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6883@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
6884@cindex symbol defaults
6885Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
6886defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
6887return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
6888default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
6889shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
6890the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
6891existed, its value is preserved:
6892
6893@smallexample
6894@group
6895SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
6896 .text : @{
6897 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
6898 @dots{}
6899 @}
6900 @dots{}
6901@}
6902@end group
6903@end smallexample
6904
3ec57632
NC
6905@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
6906@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
6907Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6908
252b5132
RH
6909@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
6910@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
6911@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 6912Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
6913Section LMA}).
6914
2e53f7d6
NC
6915@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6916@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
6917Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
6918@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
6919
252b5132
RH
6920@kindex MAX
6921@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6922Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6923
6924@kindex MIN
6925@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
6926Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
6927
6928@item NEXT(@var{exp})
6929@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
6930@cindex unallocated address, next
6931Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
6932This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
6933use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
6934output file, the two functions are equivalent.
6935
3ec57632
NC
6936@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6937@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
6938Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
6939
ba916c8a
MM
6940@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6941@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
6942Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
6943value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
6944@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
6945will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
6946can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 6947``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
6948name.
6949
252b5132
RH
6950@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
6951@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
6952@cindex section size
6953Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
6954been allocated. If the section has not been allocated when this is
6955evaluated, the linker will report an error. In the following example,
6956@code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical values:
6957@smallexample
6958@group
6959SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
6960 .output @{
6961 .start = . ;
6962 @dots{}
6963 .end = . ;
6964 @}
6965 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
6966 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
6967@dots{} @}
6968@end group
6969@end smallexample
6970
6971@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
6972@itemx sizeof_headers
6973@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
6974@cindex header size
6975Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
6976information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
6977this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
6978choose, to facilitate paging.
6979
6980@cindex not enough room for program headers
6981@cindex program headers, not enough room
6982When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
6983@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
6984number of program headers before it has determined all the section
6985addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
6986additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
6987room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
6988the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
6989script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
6990you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
6991command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
6992@end table
6993
6994@node Implicit Linker Scripts
6995@section Implicit Linker Scripts
6996@cindex implicit linker scripts
6997If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
6998an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
6999linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7000linker will report an error.
7001
7002An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7003
7004Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7005assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7006commands.
7007
7008Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7009at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7010read. This can affect archive searching.
7011
bf6d8037
HC
7012@node Plugins
7013@chapter Linker Plugins
7014
7015@cindex plugins
7016@cindex linker plugins
7017The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7018For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7019support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7020
7021Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7022be added here later.
7023
7024@menu
7025* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7026@end menu
7027
7028@node libdep Plugin
7029@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7030@cindex static library dependencies
7031Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7032just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7033optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7034within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7035rose to ascendance.
7036
7037One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7038multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7039dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7040library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7041referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7042link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7043libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7044explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7045
7046The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7047to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7048plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7049dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7050and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7051command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7052utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7053being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7054archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7055
7056For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7057library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7058the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7059
7060@smallexample
7061-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7062@end smallexample
7063
252b5132
RH
7064@ifset GENERIC
7065@node Machine Dependent
7066@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7067
7068@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7069@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7070sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7071functionality are not listed.
7072
7073@menu
36f63dca
NC
7074@ifset H8300
7075* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7076@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7077@ifset M68HC11
7078* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7079@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7080@ifset ARM
7081* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7082@end ifset
7083@ifset HPPA
7084* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7085@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7086@ifset M68K
7087* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7088@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7089@ifset MIPS
7090* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7091@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7092@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7093* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7094@end ifset
2469cfa2 7095@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7096* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7097@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7098@ifset NDS32
7099* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7100@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7101@ifset NIOSII
7102* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7103@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7104@ifset POWERPC
7105* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7106@end ifset
7107@ifset POWERPC64
7108* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7109@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7110@ifset S/390
7111* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7112@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7113@ifset SPU
7114* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7115@end ifset
74459f0e 7116@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7117* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7118@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7119@ifset WIN32
7120* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7121@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7122@ifset XTENSA
7123* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7124@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7125@end menu
7126@end ifset
7127
252b5132
RH
7128@ifset H8300
7129@ifclear GENERIC
7130@raisesections
7131@end ifclear
7132
7133@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7134@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7135
7136@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7137For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7138you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7139
7140@table @emph
7141@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7142@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7143@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7144targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7145program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7146respectively.
7147
7148@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7149@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7150@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7151@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7152sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7153page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7154(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7155@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7156top page of memory).
1502569c 7157
81f5558e
NC
7158@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7159indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7160displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7161the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7162@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7163whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7164range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7165
1502569c 7166@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7167@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7168biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7169which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7170page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7171(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7172@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7173the top page of memory).
7174
7175@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7176@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
717732 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7178changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7179(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7180@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7181the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7182@end table
7183
7184@ifclear GENERIC
7185@lowersections
7186@end ifclear
7187@end ifset
7188
36f63dca 7189@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7190@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7191@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7192@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7193@node Renesas
7194@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7195
c2dcd04e
NC
7196@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7197H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7198options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7199@end ifset
7200@end ifclear
7201
36f63dca
NC
7202@ifset ARM
7203@ifclear GENERIC
7204@raisesections
7205@end ifclear
7206
93fd0973
SC
7207@ifset M68HC11
7208@ifclear GENERIC
7209@raisesections
7210@end ifclear
7211
7212@node M68HC11/68HC12
7213@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7214
7215@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7216
7217@subsection Linker Relaxation
7218
7219For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7220optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7221
7222@table @emph
7223@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7224@item relaxing address modes
7225@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7226targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7227program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7228respectively.
7229
7230@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7231transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7232page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7233
7234@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7235When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7236of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7237addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7238@code{bset} instructions.
7239
7240@end table
7241
7242@subsection Trampoline Generation
7243
7244@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7245@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7246For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7247call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7248will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7249trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7250case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7251point to the function trampoline.
7252
7253@ifclear GENERIC
7254@lowersections
7255@end ifclear
7256@end ifset
7257
36f63dca 7258@node ARM
3674e28a 7259@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7260
7261@cindex ARM interworking support
7262@kindex --support-old-code
7263For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7264between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7265been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7266line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7267libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7268option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7269given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7270which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7271the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7272non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7273
7274@cindex thumb entry point
7275@cindex entry point, thumb
7276@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7277The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7278@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7279But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7280branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7281executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7282
ce11ba6c
KT
7283@cindex PE import table prefixing
7284@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7285The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7286the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7287element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7288import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7289
e489d0ae
PB
7290@cindex BE8
7291@kindex --be8
7292The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7293executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7294objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7295option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7296little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7297
3674e28a
PB
7298@cindex TARGET1
7299@kindex --target1-rel
7300@kindex --target1-abs
7301The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7302@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7303or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7304and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7305
7306@cindex TARGET2
7307@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7308The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7309@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7310meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7311@table @samp
7312@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7313@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7314@item abs
7315@samp{R_ARM_ABS32} (arm*-*-symbianelf)
3674e28a
PB
7316@item got-rel
7317@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7318@end table
7319
319850b4
JB
7320@cindex FIX_V4BX
7321@kindex --fix-v4bx
7322The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7323specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7324interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7325also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7326
7327In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7328linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7329@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7330
7331In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7332relocations are ignored.
7333
845b51d6
PB
7334@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7335@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7336Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7337relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7338
7339@smallexample
7340TST rM, #1
7341MOVEQ PC, rM
7342BX Rn
7343@end smallexample
7344
7345This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7346and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7347condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7348
33bfe774
JB
7349@cindex USE_BLX
7350@kindex --use-blx
7351The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7352BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7353situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7354code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7355each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7356
7357This option is enabled implicitly for SymbianOS, so there is no need to
7358specify it if you are using that target.
7359
c6dd86c6
JB
7360@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7361@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7362The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7363bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7364instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7365to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7366the support code can read the intended values.
7367
7368The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7369intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7370and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7371intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7372full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7373you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7374
7375If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7376enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7377@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7378mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7379vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7380@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7381
7382If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7383potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7384such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7385first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7386instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7387the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7388are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7389
2de70689
MGD
7390@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7391@kindex --fix-arm1176
7392@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7393The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7394in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7395are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7396unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7397
9d5777a3 7398Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7399Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7400http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7401
a504d23a
LA
7402@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7403@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7404
7405The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7406workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7407the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7408off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7409the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7410core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7411integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7412VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7413
7414The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7415necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7416
7417The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7418@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7419STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7420linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7421@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7422
7423If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7424potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7425such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7426replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7427branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7428then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7429
7430The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7431the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7432
7433The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7434they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7435there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7436occurs.
7437
7438The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7439PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7440large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7441cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7442occurs.
7443
bf21ed78
MS
7444@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7445@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7446The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7447warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7448enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7449linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7450using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7451not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7452
7453@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7454@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7455The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7456warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7457@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7458linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7459using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7460
726150b7
NC
7461@cindex PIC_VENEER
7462@kindex --pic-veneer
7463The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7464ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7465is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7466@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7467
7468@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7469@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7470The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7471code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7472perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7473placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7474controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7475The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7476duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7477group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7478code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7479where they should be placed.
7480
7481The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7482@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7483placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7484branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7485placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7486value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7487exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7488A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7489linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7490from the input sections.
7491
7492The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7493@samp{N = +1}.
7494
1a51c1a4
NC
7495Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7496only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7497otherwise.
7498
1db37fe6
YG
7499@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7500@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7501@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7502The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7503
7504The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7505
68fcca92
JW
7506@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7507@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7508@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7509The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7510
7511Please contact ARM for further details.
7512
1db37fe6
YG
7513@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7514@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7515@cindex Merging exidx entries
7516The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7517
7518@kindex --long-plt
7519@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7520The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7521which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7522entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7523
1f56df9d
JW
7524@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7525@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7526The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7527link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7528
4ba2ef8f
TP
7529@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7530All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7531Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7532@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7533veneers in memory.
7534
54ddd295
TP
7535@kindex --cmse-implib
7536@cindex Secure gateway import library
7537The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7538specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7539secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7540executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7541
0955507f
TP
7542@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7543@cindex Input import library
7544The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7545must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7546given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7547in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7548@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7549library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7550library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7551for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7552specified.
7553
36f63dca
NC
7554@ifclear GENERIC
7555@lowersections
7556@end ifclear
7557@end ifset
7558
7559@ifset HPPA
7560@ifclear GENERIC
7561@raisesections
7562@end ifclear
7563
7564@node HPPA ELF32
7565@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7566@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7567@kindex --multi-subspace
7568When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7569import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7570The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7571stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7572multiple sub-spaces.
7573
7574@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7575@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7576Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7577stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7578@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7579sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7580a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7581the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7582conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7583prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7584A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7585branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7586@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7587@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7588detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7589positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7590
7591Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7592single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7593create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7594large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7595
7596@ifclear GENERIC
7597@lowersections
7598@end ifclear
7599@end ifset
7600
7fb9f789
NC
7601@ifset M68K
7602@ifclear GENERIC
7603@raisesections
7604@end ifclear
7605
7606@node M68K
7607@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7608
7609@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7610@kindex --got=@var{type}
7611The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7612The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7613@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7614the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7615@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7616entries only at non-negative offsets.
7617@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7618entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7619support such GOTs.
7620@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7621output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7622file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7623files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7624
7625@ifclear GENERIC
7626@lowersections
7627@end ifclear
7628@end ifset
7629
833794fc
MR
7630@ifset MIPS
7631@ifclear GENERIC
7632@raisesections
7633@end ifclear
7634
7635@node MIPS
7636@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7637
7638@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7639@kindex --insn32
7640@kindex --no-insn32
7641The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7642microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7643in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7644used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7645or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7646including 16-bit ones where possible.
7647
8b10b0b3
MR
7648@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7649@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7650@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7651The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7652control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7653@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7654relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7655calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7656relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7657instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7658or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7659the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7660
833794fc
MR
7661@ifclear GENERIC
7662@lowersections
7663@end ifclear
7664@end ifset
7665
36f63dca
NC
7666@ifset MMIX
7667@ifclear GENERIC
7668@raisesections
7669@end ifclear
7670
7671@node MMIX
7672@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7673For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7674@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7675understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7676can translate between the two formats.
7677
7678There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
7679Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
7680registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
7681equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
7682@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
7683global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
7684this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
7685symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
7686
7a2de473
HPN
7687Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
7688@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
7689The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
7690of a section.
36f63dca
NC
7691
7692Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
7693are left out from an mmo file.
7694
7695@ifclear GENERIC
7696@lowersections
7697@end ifclear
7698@end ifset
7699
7700@ifset MSP430
7701@ifclear GENERIC
7702@raisesections
7703@end ifclear
7704
7705@node MSP430
7706@section @code{ld} and MSP430
7707For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
7708will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
7709just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
7710
7711@cindex MSP430 extra sections
7712The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
7713
7714@table @code
7715@item @samp{.vectors}
7716Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
7717
7718@item @samp{.bootloader}
7719Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
7720in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7721
7722@item @samp{.infomem}
7723Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
7724this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
7725
c0065db7 7726@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
7727This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
7728in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
7729
7730@item @samp{.noinit}
7731Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
7732
c0065db7 7733The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
7734@end table
7735
7ef3addb
JL
7736@table @option
7737@cindex MSP430 Options
7738@kindex --code-region
7739@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7740This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
7741argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
7742using this option.
7743
7744@kindex --data-region
7745@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
7746This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
7747[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
7748for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
7749
7750@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
7751@item --disable-sec-transformation
7752Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
7753and @code{--data-region} options.
7754This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
7755wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
7756not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
7757@end table
7758
36f63dca
NC
7759@ifclear GENERIC
7760@lowersections
7761@end ifclear
7762@end ifset
7763
35c08157
KLC
7764@ifset NDS32
7765@ifclear GENERIC
7766@raisesections
7767@end ifclear
7768
7769@node NDS32
7770@section @code{ld} and NDS32
7771@kindex relaxing on NDS32
7772For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
7773relaxes objects according to these options.
7774
7775@table @code
7776@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
7777Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
7778
7779@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
7780Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
7781
7782@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
7783Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
7784
7785@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
7786Export the EX9 table after linking.
7787
7788@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
7789Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
7790
7791@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
7792Update the existing EX9 table.
7793
7794@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
7795Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
7796
7797@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
7798Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
7799
7800@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
7801Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
7802
7803@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
7804Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
7805@end table
7806
7807@ifclear GENERIC
7808@lowersections
7809@end ifclear
7810@end ifset
7811
78058a5e
SL
7812@ifset NIOSII
7813@ifclear GENERIC
7814@raisesections
7815@end ifclear
7816
7817@node Nios II
7818@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7819@cindex Nios II call relaxation
7820@kindex --relax on Nios II
7821
7822Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
7823transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
7824which may result in @command{ld} giving
7825@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7826The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
7827trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
7828outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
7829trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
7830be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
7831larger than 256MB.
7832
7833The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
7834is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
7835@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
7836locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
7837source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
7838register as a temporary.
7839
7840Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
7841relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
7842option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
7843
7844@ifclear GENERIC
7845@lowersections
7846@end ifclear
7847@end ifset
7848
2a60a7a8
AM
7849@ifset POWERPC
7850@ifclear GENERIC
7851@raisesections
7852@end ifclear
7853
7854@node PowerPC ELF32
7855@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7856@cindex PowerPC long branches
7857@kindex --relax on PowerPC
7858Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
7859displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
7860@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
7861@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
7862the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
7863section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
7864section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
7865@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
7866both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
7867considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
7868
7869@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
7870@table @option
7871@cindex PowerPC PLT
7872@kindex --bss-plt
7873@item --bss-plt
7874Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
7875generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
7876the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
7877writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
7878@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
7879PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
7880compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
7881BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
7882
016687f8
AM
7883@kindex --secure-plt
7884@item --secure-plt
7885@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
7886@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
7887when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
7888layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
7889style BSS PLT.
7890
2a60a7a8
AM
7891@cindex PowerPC GOT
7892@kindex --sdata-got
7893@item --sdata-got
7894The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
7895sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
7896@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
7897section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
7898@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
7899@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
7900@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
7901@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
7902PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
7903pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
7904GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
7905really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
7906
7907@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
7908@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7909@item --emit-stub-syms
7910This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7911symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7912
7913@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
7914@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7915@item --no-tls-optimize
7916PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7917sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7918disable the optimization.
7919@end table
7920
7921@ifclear GENERIC
7922@lowersections
7923@end ifclear
7924@end ifset
7925
7926@ifset POWERPC64
7927@ifclear GENERIC
7928@raisesections
7929@end ifclear
7930
7931@node PowerPC64 ELF64
7932@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7933
7934@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
7935@table @option
7936@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
7937@kindex --stub-group-size
7938@item --stub-group-size
7939Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
7940by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7941@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7942sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7943a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7944the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7945conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7946prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7947A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7948branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7949@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7950@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7951detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7952positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7953
7954Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7955single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7956create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7957large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7958
7959@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
7960@kindex --emit-stub-syms
7961@item --emit-stub-syms
7962This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
7963symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
7964
7965@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
7966@kindex --dotsyms
7967@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
7968@item --dotsyms
7969@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
7970These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
7971in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
7972function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
7973code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
7974properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
7975to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
7976@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
7977dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
7978feature.
7979
7ae4ea7d
AM
7980@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
7981@kindex --save-restore-funcs
7982@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
7983@item --save-restore-funcs
7984@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
7985These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
7986provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
7987@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
7988function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
7989link.
7990
2a60a7a8
AM
7991@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
7992@kindex --no-tls-optimize
7993@item --no-tls-optimize
7994PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
7995sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
7996disable the optimization.
7997
7c9cf415
AM
7998@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
7999@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8000@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8001@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8002@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8003@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8004@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8005These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8006stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8007an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8008@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8009stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8010generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8011__tls_get_addr_opt.
8012Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8013much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8014an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8015will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8016@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8017and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8018this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8019Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8020@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8021register saves.
7c9cf415 8022
2a60a7a8
AM
8023@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8024@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8025@item --no-opd-optimize
8026PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8027corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8028the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8029Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8030
8031@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8032@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8033@item --non-overlapping-opd
8034Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8035@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8036the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8037entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8038
8039@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8040@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8041@item --no-toc-optimize
8042PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8043entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8044reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8045marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8046marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8047relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8048unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8049reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8050discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8051reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8052code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8053optimization.
8054
d882c988
AM
8055@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8056@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8057@item --no-inline-optimize
8058PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8059marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8060@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8061a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8062locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8063disables that optimization.
8064
2a60a7a8
AM
8065@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8066@kindex --no-multi-toc
8067@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8068If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8069@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8070where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8071entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8072total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8073grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8074TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8075calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8076help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
807764K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8078Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8079
8080@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8081@kindex --no-toc-sort
8082@item --no-toc-sort
8083By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8084happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8085placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8086with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8087referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8088@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8089results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8090off this feature.
8091
8092@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8093@kindex --plt-align
8094@kindex --no-plt-align
8095@item --plt-align
8096@itemx --no-plt-align
8097Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8098aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8099boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8100specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8101specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8102if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8103PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8104
8105@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8106@kindex --plt-static-chain
8107@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8108@item --plt-static-chain
8109@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8110Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8111chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8112chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8113
8114@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8115@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8116@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8117@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8118@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8119With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8120lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8121another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8122order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8123memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8124barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8125looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8126seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8127default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8128
8129@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8130@kindex --plt-localentry
8131@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8132@item --plt-localentry
8133@itemx --no-localentry
8134ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8135ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8136(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8137Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8138or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8139functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8140in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8141interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8142including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8143to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8144complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8145care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8146
8147@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8148@kindex --power10-stubs
8149@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8150@item --power10-stubs
8151@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8152When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8153relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8154linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8155for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8156power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8157power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8158allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8159@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8160auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8161@end table
8162
8163@ifclear GENERIC
8164@lowersections
8165@end ifclear
8166@end ifset
8167
b4cbbe8f
AK
8168@ifset S/390
8169@ifclear GENERIC
8170@raisesections
8171@end ifclear
8172
8173@node S/390 ELF
8174@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8175
8176@cindex S/390 ELF options
8177@table @option
8178
8179@cindex S/390
8180@kindex --s390-pgste
8181@item --s390-pgste
8182This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8183segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8184binaries marked that way.
8185@end table
8186
8187@ifclear GENERIC
8188@lowersections
8189@end ifclear
8190@end ifset
8191
49fa1e15
AM
8192@ifset SPU
8193@ifclear GENERIC
8194@raisesections
8195@end ifclear
8196
8197@node SPU ELF
8198@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8199
8200@cindex SPU ELF options
8201@table @option
8202
8203@cindex SPU plugins
8204@kindex --plugin
8205@item --plugin
8206This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8207
8208@cindex SPU overlays
8209@kindex --no-overlays
8210@item --no-overlays
8211Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8212regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8213@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8214turns off all this special overlay handling.
8215
8216@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8217@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8218@item --emit-stub-syms
8219This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8220symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8221
8222@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8223@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8224@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8225This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8226function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8227on calls to non-overlay regions.
8228
8229@cindex SPU local store size
8230@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8231@item --local-store=lo:hi
8232@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8233the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8234range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8235
c0065db7 8236@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8237@kindex --stack-analysis
8238@item --stack-analysis
8239SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8240unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8241under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8242@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8243@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8244determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8245for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8246for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8247for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8248find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8249and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8250under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8251dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8252is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8253and calls will be given.
8254
c0065db7 8255@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8256@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8257@item --emit-stack-syms
8258This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8259in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8260These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8261functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8262functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8263such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8264The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8265@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8266@end table
8267
8268@ifclear GENERIC
8269@lowersections
8270@end ifclear
8271@end ifset
8272
36f63dca
NC
8273@ifset TICOFF
8274@ifclear GENERIC
8275@raisesections
8276@end ifclear
8277
8278@node TI COFF
8279@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8280@cindex TI COFF versions
8281@kindex --format=@var{version}
8282The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8283TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8284also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8285format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8286header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8287
8288@ifclear GENERIC
8289@lowersections
8290@end ifclear
8291@end ifset
8292
2ca22b03
NC
8293@ifset WIN32
8294@ifclear GENERIC
8295@raisesections
8296@end ifclear
8297
8298@node WIN32
8299@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8300
c0065db7 8301This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8302See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8303command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8304
8305@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8306@cindex import libraries
8307@item import libraries
69da35b5 8308The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8309libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8310regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8311archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8312support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8313@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8314
c0065db7
RM
8315@item exporting DLL symbols
8316@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8317The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8318
8319@table @emph
8320@item using auto-export functionality
8321@cindex using auto-export functionality
8322By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8323which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8324
0a5d968e
NC
8325@itemize
8326@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8327@item --exclude-symbols
8328@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8329@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8330@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8331@end itemize
8332
09e2aba4
DK
8333When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8334(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8335symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8336often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8337private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8338options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8339exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8340final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8341
8342If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8343command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8344if either of the following are true:
8345
8346@itemize
8347@item A DEF file is used.
8348@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8349@end itemize
dc8465bf 8350
c0065db7
RM
8351@item using a DEF file
8352@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8353Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8354an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8355exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8356name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8357command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8358
8359@example
8360gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8361@end example
8362
0a5d968e
NC
8363Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8364@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8365
dc8465bf
NC
8366Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8367
8368@example
4b5bd4e7 8369LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8370
8371EXPORTS
8372foo
8373bar
8374_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8375another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8376var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8377doo = foo == foo2
8378eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8379@end example
dc8465bf 8380
7fcab871 8381This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8382symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8383alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8384by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8385@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8386@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8387export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8388in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8389symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8390
6b31ad16
DS
8391The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8392name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8393the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8394
b45619c0
NC
8395When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8396library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8397@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8398executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8399
8400With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8401specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8402non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8403
8404If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8405or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8406filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8407
4b5bd4e7
DS
8408The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8409
8410@example
8411EXPORTS
8412 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8413 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8414 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8415@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8416
8417Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8418@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8419@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8420@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8421Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8422@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8423string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8424
8425The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8426
8427@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8428will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8429by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8430linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8431library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8432
8433@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8434The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8435the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8436@code{*_imp__foo}).
8437
8438@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8439well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8440read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8441variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8442the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8443extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8444application will behave unexpectedly.
8445
8446@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8447it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8448symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8449API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8450the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8451
4b5bd4e7
DS
8452See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8453other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8454
8455@cindex creating a DEF file
8456While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8457with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8458
8459@item Using decorations
8460@cindex Using decorations
8461Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8462itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8463declared as:
8464
8465@example
8466__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8467__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8468@end example
8469
8470All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8471any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8472this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8473the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8474
8475Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8476decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8477instead:
8478
8479@example
8480__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8481__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8482@end example
8483
c0065db7
RM
8484This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8485when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8486variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8487code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8488of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8489omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8490@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8491information.
c0065db7 8492@end table
dc8465bf 8493
2ca22b03
NC
8494@cindex automatic data imports
8495@item automatic data imports
8496The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8497by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8498compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8499issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8500code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8501c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8502initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8503decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8504platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8505command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8506The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8507suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8508trigger the feature's use.
8509
c0065db7 8510auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8511additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8512
c0065db7 8513"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8514documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8515
c0065db7
RM
8516The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8517occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8518One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8519below.
8520
8521@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8522For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8523object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8524offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8525field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8526in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8527without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8528The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8529references.
8530
c0065db7
RM
8531The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8532be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8533themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8534runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8535compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8536support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8537run without error on an older system.
8538
c0065db7
RM
8539@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8540enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8541
8542@cindex direct linking to a dll
8543@item direct linking to a dll
8544The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8545including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8546libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8547traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8548libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8549function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8550though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8551storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8552tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8553large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8554
c0065db7 8555Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8556@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8557of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8558perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8559select the dll instead of an import library.
8560
2ca22b03 8561
69da35b5
NC
8562For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8563to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8564
8565@example
45e948fe
NC
8566libxxx.dll.a
8567xxx.dll.a
8568libxxx.a
8569xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8570libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8571cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8572libxxx.dll
8573xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8574@end example
8575
69da35b5
NC
8576before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8577
c0065db7
RM
8578(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8579where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8580@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8581file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8582@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8583
c0065db7
RM
8584Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8585@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8586was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8587various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8588could coexist on the same machine.
8589
2ca22b03
NC
8590The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8591applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8592libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8593
8594@example
8595bin/
8596 cygxxx.dll
8597lib/
8598 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8599 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8600@end example
8601
c0065db7
RM
8602Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8603done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8604
86051. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8606@example
8607gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8608@end example
2ca22b03 8609
69da35b5
NC
8610However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8611(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8612@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8613not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8614
2ca22b03
NC
86152. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8616directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8617should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8618making the app/dll.
8619
8620@example
8621ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8622@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8623
8624Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8625
8626@example
8627gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8628@end example
69da35b5
NC
8629
8630This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8631perfectly legal
8632
8633@example
8634bin/
8635 cygxxx-5.dll
8636lib/
c0065db7 8637 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8638@end example
8639
dc8465bf 8640Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8641even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8642@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8643
8644Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8645wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
8646
86471. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
8648work with auto-imported data.
8649
dc8465bf
NC
86502. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
8651import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
8652symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
8653for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
8654possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 8655
45e948fe
NC
86563. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
8657critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
8658in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
8659stdcall-decorated assembly names.
8660
69da35b5 8661So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
8662true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
8663a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
8664binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
8665massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
8666requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
8667will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 8668
c0065db7 8669@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 8670@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8671@item adding additional names
8672Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
8673A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
8674exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
8675when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 8676import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 8677
c0065db7 8678@example
dc8465bf
NC
8679LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8680
8681EXPORTS
c0065db7 8682foo
dc8465bf 8683_foo = foo
c0065db7 8684@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8685
8686The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
8687
8688Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
8689source code using the "weak" attribute:
8690
c0065db7
RM
8691@example
8692void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 8693void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 8694@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8695
8696See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
8697symbols.
8698
8699@item renaming symbols
8700Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 8701kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
8702@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
8703DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 8704created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 8705
c0065db7 8706@example
dc8465bf
NC
8707LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
8708
8709EXPORTS
8710_foo = foo
c0065db7 8711@end example
dc8465bf
NC
8712
8713The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
8714@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 8715@end table
dc8465bf 8716
0a5d968e 8717Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 8718unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 8719If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
8720@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
8721that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
8722@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
8723renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
8724to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
8725the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
8726In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 8727which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
8728
8729@cindex weak externals
8730@item weak externals
8731The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
8732weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
8733defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
8734are three variants of weak externals:
8735@itemize
8736@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
8737called lazy externals.
8738@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
8739This form is not presently implemented.
8740@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
8741implemented.
8742@end itemize
8743As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
8744are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
8745uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
8746
8747@cindex aligned common symbols
8748@item aligned common symbols
8749As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
8750desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
8751the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
8752carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
8753by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
8754tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
8755but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
8756warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 8757
2ca22b03
NC
8758@end table
8759
8760@ifclear GENERIC
8761@lowersections
8762@end ifclear
8763@end ifset
8764
e0001a05
NC
8765@ifset XTENSA
8766@ifclear GENERIC
8767@raisesections
8768@end ifclear
8769
8770@node Xtensa
8771@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
8772
8773@cindex Xtensa processors
8774The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
8775@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
8776specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
8777keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
8778example, with the command:
8779
8780@smallexample
8781SECTIONS
8782@{
8783 .text : @{
8784 *(.literal .text)
8785 @}
8786@}
8787@end smallexample
8788
8789@noindent
8790@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
8791and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
8792literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
8793interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
8794group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
8795files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
8796and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 8797
43cd72b9 8798@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 8799@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
8800Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
8801provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
8802is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
8803literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
8804will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
8805location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
8806the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
8807unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
8808@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
8809range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
8810
8811For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
8812to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
8813instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
8814instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
8815instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
8816@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
8817hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
8818By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
8819switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
8820density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
8821instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
8822performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
8823linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
8824a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
8825
8826The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
8827control the linker:
8828
8829@cindex Xtensa options
8830@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
8831@item --size-opt
8832When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
8833more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
8834no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
8835alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
8836preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
8837
8838@item --abi-windowed
8839@itemx --abi-call0
8840Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
8841PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
8842because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
8843conventions.
8844Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
8845of the first input object.
8846A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
8847or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 8848@end table
e0001a05
NC
8849
8850@ifclear GENERIC
8851@lowersections
8852@end ifclear
8853@end ifset
8854
252b5132
RH
8855@ifclear SingleFormat
8856@node BFD
8857@chapter BFD
8858
8859@cindex back end
8860@cindex object file management
8861@cindex object formats available
8862@kindex objdump -i
8863The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
8864These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
8865object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
8866format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
8867it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
8868associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
8869object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
8870(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
8871list all the formats available for your configuration.
8872
8873@cindex BFD requirements
8874@cindex requirements for BFD
8875As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
8876several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
8877BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
8878formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
8879been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
8880BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
8881may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
8882
8883One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
8884mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
8885useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
8886conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
8887
8888@menu
8889* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
8890@end menu
8891
8892@node BFD outline
36f63dca 8893@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
8894@cindex opening object files
8895@include bfdsumm.texi
8896@end ifclear
8897
8898@node Reporting Bugs
8899@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
8900@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
8901@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 8902
ff5dcc92 8903Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
8904
8905Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
8906it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 8907to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 8908work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 8909@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8910
8911In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
8912information that enables us to fix the bug.
8913
8914@menu
8915* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
8916* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
8917@end menu
8918
8919@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 8920@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
8921@cindex bug criteria
8922
8923If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
8924
8925@itemize @bullet
8926@cindex fatal signal
8927@cindex linker crash
8928@cindex crash of linker
8929@item
8930If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 8931@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
8932
8933@cindex error on valid input
8934@item
ff5dcc92 8935If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
8936
8937@cindex invalid input
8938@item
ff5dcc92 8939If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
8940may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
8941object files are correct.
8942
8943@item
8944If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 8945improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
8946@end itemize
8947
8948@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 8949@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 8950@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 8951@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
8952
8953A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 8954products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
8955recommend you contact that organization first.
8956
8957You can find contact information for many support companies and
8958individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
8959distribution.
8960
ad22bfe8 8961@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 8962Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
8963@value{BUGURL}.
8964@end ifset
252b5132
RH
8965
8966The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
8967@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
8968fact or leave it out, state it!
8969
8970Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
8971problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
8972assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
8973matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
8974the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
8975location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
8976were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
8977into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
8978specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 8979and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
8980
8981Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
8982the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
8983on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
8984
8985Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
8986bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
8987respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
8988You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
8989
8990To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
8991
8992@itemize @bullet
8993@item
ff5dcc92 8994The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
8995the @samp{--version} argument.
8996
8997Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 8998the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
8999
9000@item
ff5dcc92 9001Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9002patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9003
9004@item
9005The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9006version number.
9007
9008@item
ff5dcc92 9009What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9010``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9011
9012@item
9013The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9014observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9015list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9016sufficient.
9017
9018If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9019and then we might not encounter the bug.
9020
9021@item
9022A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9023bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9024provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9025bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9026state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9027requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9028we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9029attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9030
9031If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9032@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9033object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9034@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9035how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9036
9037@item
9038A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9039incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9040
ff5dcc92 9041Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9042will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9043not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9044a chance to make a mistake.
9045
9046Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9047say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9048copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9049C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9050and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9051fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9052you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9053any conclusion from our observations.
9054
9055@item
ff5dcc92 9056If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9057diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9058@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9059If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9060context, not by line number.
9061
9062The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9063sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9064@end itemize
9065
9066Here are some things that are not necessary:
9067
9068@itemize @bullet
9069@item
9070A description of the envelope of the bug.
9071
9072Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9073which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9074changes will not affect it.
9075
9076This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9077will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9078with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9079We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9080
9081Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9082of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9083output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9084less time, and so on.
9085
9086However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9087report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9088
9089@item
9090A patch for the bug.
9091
9092A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9093the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9094a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9095to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9096
ff5dcc92 9097Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9098construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9099through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9100able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9101fixed.
9102
9103And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9104patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9105help us to understand.
9106
9107@item
9108A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9109
9110Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9111things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9112@end itemize
9113
9114@node MRI
9115@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9116@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9117To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9118linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9119alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9120described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9121simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9122@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9123linker commands; these commands are described here.
9124
9125In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9126file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9127features to make use of them.
9128
9129You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9130@samp{-c} command-line option.
9131
9132Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9133command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9134blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9135MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9136issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9137
9138Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9139
9140You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9141lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9142The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9143
9144@table @code
9145@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9146@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9147@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9148Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9149the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9150@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9151your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9152script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9153commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9154input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9155@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9156
9157@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9158@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9159Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9160in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9161
9162@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9163
9164@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9165@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9166Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9167@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9168
9169@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9170@item BASE @var{expression}
9171Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9172absolute addresses) in the output file.
9173
9174@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9175@item CHIP @var{expression}
9176@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9177This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9178
9179@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9180@item END
9181This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9182
9183@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9184@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9185Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9186language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9187
9188@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9189@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9190Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9191@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9192
9193The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9194same line, with no change in its effect.
9195
9196@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9197@item LOAD @var{filename}
9198@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9199Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9200same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9201command line.
9202
9203@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9204@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9205@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9206MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9207option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9208
9209@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9210@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9211@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9212Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9213order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9214script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9215sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9216file, in the order specified.
9217
9218@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9219@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9220@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9221@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9222Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9223@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9224
9225@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9226@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9227@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9228@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9229You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9230specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9231If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9232@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9233@end table
9234
793c5807
NC
9235@node GNU Free Documentation License
9236@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9237@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9238
370b66a1
CD
9239@node LD Index
9240@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9241
9242@printindex cp
9243
9244@tex
7ca01ed9 9245% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9246% meantime:
9247\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9248\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9249\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9250\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9251\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9252\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9253\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9254\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9255\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9256% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9257@end tex
9258
252b5132 9259@bye